import gdb-1999-09-08 snapshot
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c
SS
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright 1988-1999
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5@c %**start of header
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
24@c readline appendices use @vindex
25@syncodeindex vr cp
26
27@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28@set EDITION Seventh
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31@set DATE February 1999
32
33@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35@ifinfo
36@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37@c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38@format
39START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42@end format
43@end ifinfo
44@c
45@c
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58are preserved on all copies.
59
60@ignore
61Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66@end ignore
67Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70permission notice identical to this one.
71
72Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74@end ifinfo
75
76@titlepage
77@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 79@sp 1
c906108c
SS
80@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81@subtitle @value{DATE}
82@author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
c906108c 83@page
c906108c
SS
84@tex
85{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 86\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
87\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89}
90@end tex
53a5351d
JM
91
92@c ISBN seems to be wrong...
c906108c
SS
93
94@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96@sp 2
c906108c
SS
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9859 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
c906108c
SS
102
103Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105are preserved on all copies.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110permission notice identical to this one.
111
112Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114@end titlepage
115@page
116
117@ifinfo
53a5351d 118@node Top
c906108c
SS
119@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124@value{GDBVN}.
125
126Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127@menu
128* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 129* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
130
131* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135* Stack:: Examining the stack
136* Source:: Examining source files
137* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 138
7a292a7a 139* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
140
141* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142* Altering:: Altering execution
143* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 148* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c906108c
SS
149
150* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 151* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
152
153* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
156* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
157@end menu
158
159@end ifinfo
160
53a5351d 161@node Summary
c906108c
SS
162@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
163
164The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
165going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
166program was doing at the moment it crashed.
167
168@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
169these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
170
171@itemize @bullet
172@item
173Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
174
175@item
176Make your program stop on specified conditions.
177
178@item
179Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
180
181@item
182Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
183effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
184@end itemize
185
cce74817 186You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 187For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
188For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
189
cce74817
JM
190@cindex Chill
191@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 192Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 193see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 194
cce74817
JM
195@cindex Pascal
196Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
197nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
198entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
199syntax.
c906108c 200
c906108c
SS
201@cindex Fortran
202@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 203it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 204underscore.
c906108c 205
c906108c
SS
206@menu
207* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
208* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
209@end menu
210
53a5351d 211@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
212@unnumberedsec Free software
213
214@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
215General Public License
216(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
217program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
218freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
219the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
220Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
221Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
222
223Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
224you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
225from anyone else.
226
53a5351d 227@node Contributors
c906108c
SS
228@unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
229
230Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
231@sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
232This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
233of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
234regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
235@file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
236blow-by-blow account.
237
238Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
239
240@quotation
241@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
242or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
243omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
244@end quotation
245
246So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
247particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
248releases:
249Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
250Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
251Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
252Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
253Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
254John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
255Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
256and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
257
258Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
259Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
260
c906108c
SS
261Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
262with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
263Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
264TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
265
266@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
267object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
268Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
269
270David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
271the original support for encapsulated COFF.
272
273Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
274
275Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
276Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
277support.
278Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
279Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
280Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
281David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
282Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
283Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
284Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
285Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
286Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
287Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
288Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
289Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
290Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
291Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
292Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
293
294Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
295
296Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
297libraries.
298
299Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
300about several machine instruction sets.
301
302Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
303remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
304contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
305and RDI targets, respectively.
306
307Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
308command-line editing and command history.
309
7a292a7a
SS
310Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
311Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c
SS
312
313Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
314He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
315symbols.
c906108c
SS
316
317Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
318Super-H processors.
319
320NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
321
322Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
323
324Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
325
326Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
327
328Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
329
330Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
331watchpoints.
332
333Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
334
335Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
336
337Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
338nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
339
340The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
341support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
342(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
343compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
344John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
345Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
346information in this manual.
347
348Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
349development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
350fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Edith Epstein,
351Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu
352Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler, Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey
353Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan
354Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In addition, Dave Brolley, Ian
355Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ
356Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug Evans, Sean Fagan, David
357Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke,
358Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore,
359Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith,
360Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron
361Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David Zuhn have made contributions both large
362and small.
363
364
53a5351d 365@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
366@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
367
368You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
369However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
370debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
371
372@iftex
373In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
374to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
375@end iftex
376
377@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
378@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
379
380One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
381processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
382quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
383definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
384session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
385then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
386same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
387@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
388procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
389
390@smallexample
391$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
392$ @b{./m4}
393@b{define(foo,0000)}
394
395@b{foo}
3960000
397@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
398
399@b{bar}
4000000
401@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
402
403@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
404@b{baz}
405@b{C-d}
406m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
407@end smallexample
408
409@noindent
410Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
411
c906108c
SS
412@smallexample
413$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
414@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
415@c FIXME... format to come out better.
416@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
417 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
418 the conditions.
419There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
420 for details.
421
422@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
423(@value{GDBP})
424@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
425
426@noindent
427@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
428rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
429We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
430that examples fit in this manual.
431
432@smallexample
433(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
434@end smallexample
435
436@noindent
437We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
438Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
439@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
440@code{break} command.
441
442@smallexample
443(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
444Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
445@end smallexample
446
447@noindent
448Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
449control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
450subroutine, the program runs as usual:
451
452@smallexample
453(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
454Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
455@b{define(foo,0000)}
456
457@b{foo}
4580000
459@end smallexample
460
461@noindent
462To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
463suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
464context where it stops.
465
466@smallexample
467@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
468
469Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
470 at builtin.c:879
471879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
472@end smallexample
473
474@noindent
475Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
476the next line of the current function.
477
478@smallexample
479(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
480882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
481 : nil,
482@end smallexample
483
484@noindent
485@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
486by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
487@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
488subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
489
490@smallexample
491(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
492set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
493 at input.c:530
494530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
495@end smallexample
496
497@noindent
498The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
499suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
500shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
501command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
502in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
503stack frame for each active subroutine.
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
507#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
508 at input.c:530
509#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
510 at builtin.c:882
511#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
512#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
513 at macro.c:71
514#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
515#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
520times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
521falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
522
523@smallexample
524(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5250x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
526(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5270x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
528def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
529(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
530536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
531 : xstrdup(rq);
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
534@end smallexample
535
536@noindent
537The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
538@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
539and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
540(@code{print}) to see their values.
541
542@smallexample
543(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
544$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
545(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
546$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
547@end smallexample
548
549@noindent
550@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
551To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
552surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
553
554@smallexample
555(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
556533 xfree(rquote);
557534
558535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
559 : xstrdup (lq);
560536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
561 : xstrdup (rq);
562537
563538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
564539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
565540 @}
566541
567542 void
568@end smallexample
569
570@noindent
571Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
572@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
573
574@smallexample
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
578540 @}
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
580$3 = 9
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
582$4 = 7
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
587@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
588@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
589the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
590any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
591assignments.
592
593@smallexample
594(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
595$5 = 7
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
597$6 = 9
598@end smallexample
599
600@noindent
601Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
602@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
603executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
604example that caused trouble initially:
605
606@smallexample
607(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
608Continuing.
609
610@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
611
612baz
6130000
614@end smallexample
615
616@noindent
617Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
618problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
619lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
620
621@smallexample
622@b{C-d}
623Program exited normally.
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
628indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
629session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
633@end smallexample
c906108c 634
53a5351d 635@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
636@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
637
638This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
639The essentials are:
640@itemize @bullet
641@item
53a5351d 642type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
643@item
644type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
645@end itemize
646
647@menu
648* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
649* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
650* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
651@end menu
652
53a5351d 653@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
654@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
655
c906108c
SS
656Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
657@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
658
659You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
660to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
661
c906108c
SS
662The command-line options described here are designed
663to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
664options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
665
666The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
667specifying an executable program:
668
669@example
670@value{GDBP} @var{program}
671@end example
672
c906108c
SS
673@noindent
674You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
675specified:
676
677@example
678@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
679@end example
680
681You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
682to debug a running process:
683
684@example
685@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
686@end example
687
688@noindent
689would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
690named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
691
c906108c
SS
692Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
693complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote debugger
694attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of ``process'',
695and there is often no way to get a core dump.
c906108c
SS
696
697You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
698@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
699
700@smallexample
701@value{GDBP} -silent
702@end smallexample
703
704@noindent
705You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
706options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
707
708@noindent
709Type
710
711@example
712@value{GDBP} -help
713@end example
714
715@noindent
716to display all available options and briefly describe their use
717(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
718
719All options and command line arguments you give are processed
720in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
721@samp{-x} option is used.
722
723
724@menu
c906108c
SS
725* File Options:: Choosing files
726* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
727@end menu
728
c906108c
SS
729@node File Options
730@subsection Choosing files
731
53a5351d 732When @value{GDBN} starts
c906108c
SS
733specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
734the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
735@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
736that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
737@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
738that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
739the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
740
741If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
742such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
743argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
744
745Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
746following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
747them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
748(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
749than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
750
751@table @code
752@item -symbols @var{file}
753@itemx -s @var{file}
754Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
755
756@item -exec @var{file}
757@itemx -e @var{file}
7a292a7a
SS
758Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
759and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
760
761@item -se @var{file}
762Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
763file.
764
c906108c
SS
765@item -core @var{file}
766@itemx -c @var{file}
767Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
768
769@item -c @var{number}
770Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
771(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
772case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
773
774@item -command @var{file}
775@itemx -x @var{file}
776Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
777Files,, Command files}.
778
779@item -directory @var{directory}
780@itemx -d @var{directory}
781Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
782
c906108c
SS
783@item -m
784@itemx -mapped
785@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
786supported on all systems.}@*
787If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
788system call, you can use this option
789to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
790program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
791called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
792Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
793and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
794the symbol table from the executable program.
795
796The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
797is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
798table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 799
c906108c
SS
800@item -r
801@itemx -readnow
802Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
803the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
804This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 805
c906108c
SS
806@end table
807
c906108c
SS
808The @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options are typically combined in
809order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
810information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for
d4f3574e 811information on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do
c906108c
SS
812nothing but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
813
814@example
815 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
816@end example
c906108c 817
53a5351d 818@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
819@subsection Choosing modes
820
821You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
822batch mode or quiet mode.
823
824@table @code
825@item -nx
826@itemx -n
827Do not execute commands from any initialization files (normally called
828@file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally, the commands in
829these files are executed after all the command options and arguments
830have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command files}.
831
832@item -quiet
833@itemx -q
834``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
835messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
836
837@item -batch
838Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
839command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
840initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
841nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
842in the command files.
843
844Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
845download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
846more useful, the message
847
848@example
849Program exited normally.
850@end example
851
852@noindent
853(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
854terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
855
856@item -cd @var{directory}
857Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
858instead of the current directory.
859
c906108c
SS
860@item -fullname
861@itemx -f
7a292a7a
SS
862@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
863subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
864number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
865displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
866recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
867the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
868and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
869@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
870frame.
c906108c 871
c906108c
SS
872@item -b @var{bps}
873Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
874interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
875
876@item -tty @var{device}
877Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
878@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 879
53a5351d
JM
880@c resolve the situation of these eventually
881@c @item -tui
882@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
883@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
884@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
885@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
886@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
887
888@c @item -xdb
889@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
890@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
891@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
892@c systems.
893
c906108c
SS
894@end table
895
53a5351d 896@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
897@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
898@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
899@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
900
901@table @code
902@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
903@kindex q
904@item quit
905To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
906type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
907@var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
908terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
909@end table
910
911@cindex interrupt
912An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
913terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
914returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
915character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
916until a time when it is safe.
917
c906108c
SS
918If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
919device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
920(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 921
53a5351d 922@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
923@section Shell commands
924
925If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
926debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
927just use the @code{shell} command.
928
929@table @code
930@kindex shell
931@cindex shell escape
932@item shell @var{command string}
933Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 934If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
935shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
936(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
937@end table
938
939The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
940You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
941@value{GDBN}:
942
943@table @code
944@kindex make
945@cindex calling make
946@item make @var{make-args}
947Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
948arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
949@end table
950
53a5351d 951@node Commands
c906108c
SS
952@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
953
954You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
955name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
956@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
957key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
958show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
959
960@menu
961* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
962* Completion:: Command completion
963* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
964@end menu
965
53a5351d 966@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
967@section Command syntax
968
969A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
970how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
971arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
972command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
973step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
974with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
975
976@cindex abbreviation
977@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
978unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
979documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
980abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
981equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
982names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
983arguments to the @code{help} command.
984
985@cindex repeating commands
986@kindex RET
987A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
988repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
989will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
990repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
991repeat.
992
993The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
994@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
995exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
996
997@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
998output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
999(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1000@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1001repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1002
1003@kindex #
1004@cindex comment
1005Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1006nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1007Files,,Command files}).
1008
53a5351d 1009@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1010@section Command completion
1011
1012@cindex completion
1013@cindex word completion
1014@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1015only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1016are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1017commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1018
1019Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1020of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1021word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1022enter it). For example, if you type
1023
1024@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1025@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1026@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1027@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1028@example
1029(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1030@end example
1031
1032@noindent
1033@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1034the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1035
1036@example
1037(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1038@end example
1039
1040@noindent
1041You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1042breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1043@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1044were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1045might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1046to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1047
1048If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1049@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1050characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1051@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1052example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1053begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1054just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1055function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1056example:
1057
1058@example
1059(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1060@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1061make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1062make_abs_section make_function_type
1063make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1064make_cleanup make_reference_type
1065make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1066(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1067@end example
1068
1069@noindent
1070After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1071partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1072command.
1073
1074If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1075can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1076means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1077key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1078one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1079
1080@cindex quotes in commands
1081@cindex completion of quoted strings
1082Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1083parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1084its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1085situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1086@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1087
c906108c
SS
1088The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1089name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1090(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1091type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1092distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1093@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1094@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1095facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1096beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1097consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1098@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1099
1100@example
1101(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1102bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1103(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1104@end example
1105
1106In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1107quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1108completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1109place:
1110
1111@example
1112(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1113@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1114(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1115@end example
1116
1117@noindent
1118In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1119you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1120completion on an overloaded symbol.
1121
d4f3574e 1122For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1123expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1124overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1125see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1126
1127
53a5351d 1128@node Help
c906108c
SS
1129@section Getting help
1130@cindex online documentation
1131@kindex help
1132
1133You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1134using the command @code{help}.
1135
1136@table @code
1137@kindex h
1138@item help
1139@itemx h
1140You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1141display a short list of named classes of commands:
1142
1143@smallexample
1144(@value{GDBP}) help
1145List of classes of commands:
1146
1147running -- Running the program
1148stack -- Examining the stack
1149data -- Examining data
1150breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1151files -- Specifying and examining files
1152status -- Status inquiries
1153support -- Support facilities
1154user-defined -- User-defined commands
1155aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1156obscure -- Obscure features
1157
1158Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1159commands in that class.
1160Type "help" followed by command name for full
1161documentation.
1162Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1163(@value{GDBP})
1164@end smallexample
1165
1166@item help @var{class}
1167Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1168list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1169help display for the class @code{status}:
1170
1171@smallexample
1172(@value{GDBP}) help status
1173Status inquiries.
1174
1175List of commands:
1176
1177@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1178@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1179show -- Generic command for showing things set
1180 with "set"
1181info -- Generic command for printing status
1182
1183Type "help" followed by command name for full
1184documentation.
1185Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1186(@value{GDBP})
1187@end smallexample
1188
1189@item help @var{command}
1190With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1191short paragraph on how to use that command.
1192
1193@kindex complete
1194@item complete @var{args}
1195The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1196for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1197command you want completed. For example:
1198
1199@smallexample
1200complete i
1201@end smallexample
1202
1203@noindent results in:
1204
1205@smallexample
1206@group
1207info
1208inspect
1209ignore
1210@end group
1211@end smallexample
1212
1213@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1214@end table
1215
1216In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1217and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1218of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1219manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1220under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1221all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1222
1223@c @group
1224@table @code
1225@kindex info
1226@kindex i
1227@item info
1228This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1229program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1230with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1231registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1232You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1233@w{@code{help info}}.
1234
1235@kindex set
1236@item set
1237You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1238@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1239@code{set prompt $}.
1240
1241@kindex show
1242@item show
1243In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1244@value{GDBN} itself.
1245You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1246related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1247system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1248which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1249
1250@kindex info set
1251To display all the settable parameters and their current
1252values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1253@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1254@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1255@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1256@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1257@end table
1258@c @end group
1259
1260Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1261exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1262
1263@table @code
1264@kindex show version
1265@cindex version number
1266@item show version
1267Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1268information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of @value{GDBN} are in
1269use at your site, you may occasionally want to determine which version
1270of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new commands are introduced,
1271and old ones may wither away. The version number is also announced
1272when you start @value{GDBN}.
1273
1274@kindex show copying
1275@item show copying
1276Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1277
1278@kindex show warranty
1279@item show warranty
1280Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement.
1281@end table
1282
53a5351d 1283@node Running
c906108c
SS
1284@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1285
1286When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1287debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1288
1289You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1290of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1291your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1292kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1293
1294@menu
1295* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1296* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1297* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1298* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1299
1300* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1301* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1302* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1303* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1304
1305* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1306* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1307@end menu
1308
53a5351d 1309@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1310@section Compiling for debugging
1311
1312In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1313debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1314is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1315variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1316and addresses in the executable code.
1317
1318To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1319the compiler.
1320
1321Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1322options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1323executables containing debugging information.
1324
53a5351d
JM
1325@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1326without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1327recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1328program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1329in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1330
1331@cindex optimized code, debugging
1332@cindex debugging optimized code
1333When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1334optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1335really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1336exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1337variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1338variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1339
1340Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1341@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1342doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1343please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1344
1345Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1346@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1347format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1348
1349@need 2000
53a5351d 1350@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1351@section Starting your program
1352@cindex starting
1353@cindex running
1354
1355@table @code
1356@kindex run
1357@item run
1358@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1359Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1360You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1361argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1362@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1363(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1364
1365@end table
1366
c906108c
SS
1367If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1368supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1369that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1370@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1371
1372The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1373receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1374information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1375can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1376your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1377divided into four categories:
1378
1379@table @asis
1380@item The @emph{arguments.}
1381Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1382@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1383is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1384(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1385the arguments.
1386In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1387@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1388@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1389
1390@item The @emph{environment.}
1391Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1392use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1393environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1394your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1395
1396@item The @emph{working directory.}
1397Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1398the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1399@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1400
1401@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1402Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1403standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1404in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1405set a different device for your program.
1406@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1407
1408@cindex pipes
1409@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1410pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1411program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1412wrong program.
1413@end table
c906108c
SS
1414
1415When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1416immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1417of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1418stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1419or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1420
1421If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1422time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1423table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1424your current breakpoints.
1425
53a5351d 1426@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1427@section Your program's arguments
1428
1429@cindex arguments (to your program)
1430The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1431@code{run} command.
1432They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1433performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1434@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1435@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1436the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1437
1438On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1439@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1440calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1441the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1442
1443@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1444@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1445
1446@kindex set args
1447@table @code
1448@item set args
1449Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1450@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1451with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1452using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1453it again without arguments.
1454
1455@kindex show args
1456@item show args
1457Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1458@end table
1459
53a5351d 1460@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1461@section Your program's environment
1462
1463@cindex environment (of your program)
1464The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1465their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1466your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1467path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1468the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1469debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1470environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1471
1472@table @code
1473@kindex path
1474@item path @var{directory}
1475Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1476(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1477You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1478system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1479MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1480is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1481
1482You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1483working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1484use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1485@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1486@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1487@var{directory} to the search path.
1488@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1489@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1490
1491@kindex show paths
1492@item show paths
1493Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1494environment variable).
1495
1496@kindex show environment
1497@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1498Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1499your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1500print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1501your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1502
1503@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1504@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1505Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1506changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1507be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1508any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1509parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1510null value.
1511@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1512@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1513
1514For example, this command:
1515
1516@example
1517set env USER = foo
1518@end example
1519
1520@noindent
d4f3574e 1521tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1522@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1523are not actually required.)
1524
1525@kindex unset environment
1526@item unset environment @var{varname}
1527Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1528program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1529@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1530rather than assigning it an empty value.
1531@end table
1532
d4f3574e
SS
1533@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1534the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1535by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1536@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1537that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1538@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1539your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1540files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1541@file{.profile}.
1542
53a5351d 1543@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1544@section Your program's working directory
1545
1546@cindex working directory (of your program)
1547Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1548working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1549The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1550from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1551working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1552
1553The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1554that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1555specify files}.
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex cd
1559@item cd @var{directory}
1560Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1561
1562@kindex pwd
1563@item pwd
1564Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1565@end table
1566
53a5351d 1567@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1568@section Your program's input and output
1569
1570@cindex redirection
1571@cindex i/o
1572@cindex terminal
1573By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1574the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1575to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1576modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1577running your program.
1578
1579@table @code
1580@kindex info terminal
1581@item info terminal
1582Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1583program is using.
1584@end table
1585
1586You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1587redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1588
1589@example
1590run > outfile
1591@end example
1592
1593@noindent
1594starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1595
1596@kindex tty
1597@cindex controlling terminal
1598Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1599with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1600argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1601commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1602process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1603
1604@example
1605tty /dev/ttyb
1606@end example
1607
1608@noindent
1609directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1610default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1611that as their controlling terminal.
1612
1613An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1614effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1615terminal.
1616
1617When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1618command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1619for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1620
53a5351d 1621@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1622@section Debugging an already-running process
1623@kindex attach
1624@cindex attach
1625
1626@table @code
1627@item attach @var{process-id}
1628This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1629outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1630targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1631find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1632or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1633
1634@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1635executing the command.
1636@end table
1637
1638To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1639which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1640programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1641also have permission to send the process a signal.
1642
1643When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1644the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1645the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1646(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1647the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1648Specify Files}.
1649
1650The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1651process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1652with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1653you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1654can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1655process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1656attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1657
1658@table @code
1659@kindex detach
1660@item detach
1661When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1662@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1663the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1664that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1665are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1666@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1667executing the command.
1668@end table
1669
1670If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1671attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1672for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1673control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1674confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1675messages}).
1676
53a5351d 1677@node Kill Process
c906108c 1678@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1679
1680@table @code
1681@kindex kill
1682@item kill
1683Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1684@end table
1685
1686This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1687running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1688is running.
1689
1690On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1691while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1692@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1693outside the debugger.
1694
1695The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1696relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1697executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1698next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1699reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1700breakpoint settings).
1701
53a5351d 1702@node Threads
c906108c 1703@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1704
1705@cindex threads of execution
1706@cindex multiple threads
1707@cindex switching threads
1708In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1709may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1710of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1711the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1712that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1713modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1714registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1715
1716@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1717programs:
1718
1719@itemize @bullet
1720@item automatic notification of new threads
1721@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1722@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1723@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1724a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1725@item thread-specific breakpoints
1726@end itemize
1727
c906108c
SS
1728@quotation
1729@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1730@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1731If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1732effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1733from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1734like this:
1735
1736@smallexample
1737(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1738(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1739Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1740see the IDs of currently known threads.
1741@end smallexample
1742@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1743@c doesn't support threads"?
1744@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1745
1746@cindex focus of debugging
1747@cindex current thread
1748The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1749threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1750control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1751This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1752program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1753
c906108c
SS
1754@kindex New @var{systag}
1755@cindex thread identifier (system)
1756@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1757@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1758@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1759Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1760the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1761form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1762whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1763LynxOS, you might see
1764
1765@example
1766[New process 35 thread 27]
1767@end example
1768
1769@noindent
1770when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1771the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1772further qualifier.
1773
1774@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1775@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1776@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1777@c program?
1778@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1779@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1780@c threads ab initio?
1781
1782@cindex thread number
1783@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1784For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1785number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1786
1787@table @code
1788@kindex info threads
1789@item info threads
1790Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1791program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1792
1793@enumerate
1794@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1795
1796@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1797
1798@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1799@end enumerate
1800
1801@noindent
1802An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1803indicates the current thread.
1804
1805For example,
1806@end table
1807@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1808
1809@smallexample
1810(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1811 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1812 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1813* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1814 at threadtest.c:68
1815@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
1816
1817On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
1818
1819@cindex thread number
1820@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1821For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1822number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1823thread in your program.
1824
1825@kindex New @var{systag}
1826@cindex thread identifier (system)
1827@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1828@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1829@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1830Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1831both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1832form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1833whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1834HP-UX, you see
1835
1836@example
1837[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1838@end example
1839
1840@noindent
1841when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1842
1843@table @code
1844@kindex info threads
1845@item info threads
1846Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1847program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1848
1849@enumerate
1850@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1851
1852@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1853
1854@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1855@end enumerate
1856
1857@noindent
1858An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1859indicates the current thread.
1860
1861For example,
1862@end table
1863@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1864
1865@example
1866(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1867 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
1868 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1869 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1870@end example
c906108c
SS
1871
1872@table @code
1873@kindex thread @var{threadno}
1874@item thread @var{threadno}
1875Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
1876argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
1877shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
1878@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
1879you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
1880
1881@smallexample
1882@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
1883(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 1884[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
18850x34e5 in sigpause ()
1886@end smallexample
1887
1888@noindent
1889As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
1890@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
1891threads.
1892
1893@kindex thread apply
1894@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
1895The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
1896more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
1897with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
1898@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
1899threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
1900@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
1901@end table
1902
1903@cindex automatic thread selection
1904@cindex switching threads automatically
1905@cindex threads, automatic switching
1906Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
1907signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
1908signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
1909message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
1910thread.
1911
1912@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
1913more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
1914programs with multiple threads.
1915
1916@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
1917watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 1918
53a5351d 1919@node Processes
c906108c
SS
1920@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
1921
1922@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
1923@cindex multiple processes
1924@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
1925On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
1926programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
1927function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
1928parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
1929set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
1930will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
1931will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
1932
1933However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
1934which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
1935the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
1936only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
1937so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
1938on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
1939get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
1940@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 1941the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 1942the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 1943
53a5351d
JM
1944On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
1945debugging programs that create additional processes using the
1946@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
1947
1948By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
1949the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
1950
1951If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
1952use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
1953
1954@table @code
1955@kindex set follow-fork-mode
1956@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
1957Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
1958@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
1959process. The @var{mode} can be:
1960
1961@table @code
1962@item parent
1963The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
1964unimpeded.
1965
1966@item child
1967The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
1968unimpeded.
1969
1970@item ask
1971The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
1972@end table
1973
1974@item show follow-fork-mode
1975Display the current debugger response to a fork or vfork call.
1976@end table
1977
1978If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
1979@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
1980breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
1981@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
1982the child process's @code{main}.
1983
1984When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
1985child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
1986
1987If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
1988call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
1989use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
1990argument.
1991
1992You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
1993a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
1994Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 1995
53a5351d 1996@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
1997@chapter Stopping and Continuing
1998
1999The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2000program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2001trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2002
7a292a7a
SS
2003Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2004such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2005@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2006change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2007continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2008ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2009explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2010
2011@table @code
2012@kindex info program
2013@item info program
2014Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2015running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2016@end table
2017
2018@menu
2019* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2020* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2021* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2022* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2023@end menu
2024
53a5351d 2025@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2026@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2027
2028@cindex breakpoints
2029A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2030the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2031control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2032breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2033Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2034should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2035program.
2036
2037In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2038breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2039a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2040is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2041not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2042arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2043
2044@cindex watchpoints
2045@cindex memory tracing
2046@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2047@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2048A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2049when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2050command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2051watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2052any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2053and watchpoints using the same commands.
2054
2055You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2056whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2057Automatic display}.
2058
2059@cindex catchpoints
2060@cindex breakpoint on events
2061A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2062when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2063exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2064different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2065catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2066other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2067@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2068
2069@cindex breakpoint numbers
2070@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2071@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2072catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2073starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2074features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2075breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2076@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2077enable it again.
2078
2079@menu
2080* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2081* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2082* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2083* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2084* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2085* Conditions:: Break conditions
2086* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2087* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2088* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2089@end menu
2090
53a5351d 2091@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2092@subsection Setting breakpoints
2093
2094@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2095@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2096@c
2097@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2098
2099@kindex break
2100@kindex b
2101@kindex $bpnum
2102@cindex latest breakpoint
2103Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2104@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2105number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2106Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2107convenience variables.
2108
2109You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2110
2111@table @code
2112@item break @var{function}
2113Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2114When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2115C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2116@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2117
2118@item break +@var{offset}
2119@itemx break -@var{offset}
2120Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e
SS
2121at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2122(@xref{Frames, , Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2123
2124@item break @var{linenum}
2125Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2126The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2127The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2128code on that line.
2129
2130@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2131Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2132
2133@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2134Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2135@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2136superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2137functions.
2138
2139@item break *@var{address}
2140Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2141breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2142information or source files.
2143
2144@item break
2145When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2146the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2147(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2148innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2149returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2150@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2151that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2152@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2153the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2154inside loops.
2155
2156@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2157least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2158would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2159breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2160existed when your program stopped.
2161
2162@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2163Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2164@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2165value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2166@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2167above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2168,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2169
2170@kindex tbreak
2171@item tbreak @var{args}
2172Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2173same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2174way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2175program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2176
c906108c
SS
2177@kindex hbreak
2178@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2179Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2180@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2181breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2182have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2183debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2184changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2185provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2186will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2187address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2188breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2189example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2190@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2191or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2192(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2193
2194@kindex thbreak
2195@item thbreak @var{args}
2196Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2197are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2198the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2199the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2200first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2201command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2202may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2203See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2204
2205@kindex rbreak
2206@cindex regular expression
2207@item rbreak @var{regex}
2208@c FIXME what kind of regexp?
2209Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2210@var{regex}. This command
2211sets an unconditional breakpoint on all matches, printing a list of all
2212breakpoints it set. Once these breakpoints are set, they are treated
2213just like the breakpoints set with the @code{break} command. You can
2214delete them, disable them, or make them conditional the same way as any
2215other breakpoint.
2216
c906108c
SS
2217When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2218breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2219classes.
c906108c
SS
2220
2221@kindex info breakpoints
2222@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2223@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2224@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2225@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2226Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2227not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2228
2229@table @emph
2230@item Breakpoint Numbers
2231@item Type
2232Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2233@item Disposition
2234Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2235@item Enabled or Disabled
2236Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2237that are not enabled.
2238@item Address
2239Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address
2240@item What
2241Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2242line number.
2243@end table
2244
2245@noindent
2246If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2247the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2248are listed after that.
2249
2250@noindent
2251@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2252number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2253convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2254the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2255listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2256
2257@noindent
2258@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2259has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2260@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2261hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2262was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2263will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2264@end table
2265
2266@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2267your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2268the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2269(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2270
2271@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2272@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2273@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2274purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2275These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2276@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2277
2278You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2279@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2280
2281@table @code
2282@kindex maint info breakpoints
2283@item maint info breakpoints
2284Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2285breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2286internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2287breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2288is shown:
2289
2290@table @code
2291@item breakpoint
2292Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2293
2294@item watchpoint
2295Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2296
2297@item longjmp
2298Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2299@code{longjmp} calls.
2300
2301@item longjmp resume
2302Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2303
2304@item until
2305Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2306
2307@item finish
2308Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2309
c906108c
SS
2310@item shlib events
2311Shared library events.
53a5351d 2312
c906108c 2313@end table
53a5351d 2314
c906108c
SS
2315@end table
2316
2317
53a5351d 2318@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2319@subsection Setting watchpoints
2320
2321@cindex setting watchpoints
2322@cindex software watchpoints
2323@cindex hardware watchpoints
2324You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2325expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2326this may happen.
2327
2328Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2329hardware. GDB does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2330program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2331times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2332catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2333culprit.)
2334
d4f3574e
SS
2335On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2336GDB includes support for
c906108c
SS
2337hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2338program.
2339
2340@table @code
2341@kindex watch
2342@item watch @var{expr}
2343Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2344is written into by the program and its value changes.
2345
2346@kindex rwatch
2347@item rwatch @var{expr}
2348Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2349
2350@kindex awatch
2351@item awatch @var{expr}
d4f3574e 2352Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{args} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2353by the program.
c906108c
SS
2354
2355@kindex info watchpoints
2356@item info watchpoints
2357This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2358it is the same as @code{info break}.
2359@end table
2360
2361@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2362watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2363value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2364cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2365executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2366statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2367
2368When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2369
2370@example
2371Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2372@end example
2373
2374@noindent
2375if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2376
7be570e7
JM
2377Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2378hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2379value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2380every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2381that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2382hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2383will print a message like this:
2384
2385@smallexample
2386Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2387@end smallexample
2388
2389Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2390data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2391watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2392can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2393cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2394double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2395wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2396into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2397
2398If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2399to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2400Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2401time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2402able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2403warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2404
2405@smallexample
2406Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2407@end smallexample
2408
2409@noindent
2410If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2411
2412The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2413or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2414data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2415hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2416both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2417watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2418@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2419watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2420@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2421Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2422
2423If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2424any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until GDB reaches another
2425kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2426
7be570e7
JM
2427@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2428(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2429they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2430which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2431being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2432and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2433rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2434way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2435@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2436
c906108c
SS
2437@quotation
2438@cindex watchpoints and threads
2439@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2440@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2441usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2442can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2443you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2444thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2445can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2446@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2447the expression.
53a5351d 2448
d4f3574e 2449@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2450@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2451have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2452watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2453single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2454change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2455confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2456software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2457when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2458watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2459@end quotation
c906108c 2460
53a5351d 2461@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2462@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2463@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2464@cindex exception handlers
2465@cindex event handling
2466
2467You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2468kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2469shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2470
2471@table @code
2472@kindex catch
2473@item catch @var{event}
2474Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2475@table @code
2476@item throw
2477@kindex catch throw
2478The throwing of a C++ exception.
2479
2480@item catch
2481@kindex catch catch
2482The catching of a C++ exception.
2483
2484@item exec
2485@kindex catch exec
2486A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2487
2488@item fork
2489@kindex catch fork
2490A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2491
2492@item vfork
2493@kindex catch vfork
2494A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2495
2496@item load
2497@itemx load @var{libname}
2498@kindex catch load
2499The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2500@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2501
2502@item unload
2503@itemx unload @var{libname}
2504@kindex catch unload
2505The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2506of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2507@end table
2508
2509@item tcatch @var{event}
2510Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2511automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2512
2513@end table
2514
2515Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2516
2517There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2518(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2519
2520@itemize @bullet
2521@item
2522If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2523control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2524raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2525returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2526simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2527that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2528you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2529disabled within interactive calls.
2530
2531@item
2532You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2533
2534@item
2535You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2536@end itemize
2537
2538@cindex raise exceptions
2539Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2540if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2541stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2542can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2543breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2544out where the exception was raised.
2545
2546To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2547knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2548raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2549which has the following ANSI C interface:
2550
2551@example
2552 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2553 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2554 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2555@end example
2556
2557@noindent
2558To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2559unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2560(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2561
2562With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2563that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2564a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2565breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2566raised.
2567
2568
53a5351d 2569@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2570@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2571
2572@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2573@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2574It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2575catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2576to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2577breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2578
2579With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2580where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2581delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2582their breakpoint numbers.
2583
2584It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2585automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2586when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2587
2588@table @code
2589@kindex clear
2590@item clear
2591Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2592selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2593the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2594breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2595
2596@item clear @var{function}
2597@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2598Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2599
2600@item clear @var{linenum}
2601@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2602Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2603
2604@cindex delete breakpoints
2605@kindex delete
2606@kindex d
2607@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2608Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the numbers
2609specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2610breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2611confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2612@end table
2613
53a5351d 2614@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2615@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2616
2617@kindex disable breakpoints
2618@kindex enable breakpoints
2619Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2620prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2621it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2622that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2623
2624You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2625the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2626or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2627@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2628catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2629
2630A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2631states of enablement:
2632
2633@itemize @bullet
2634@item
2635Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2636with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2637@item
2638Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2639@item
2640Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2641disabled.
c906108c
SS
2642@item
2643Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2644immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2645set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2646@end itemize
2647
2648You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2649watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2650
2651@table @code
2652@kindex disable breakpoints
2653@kindex disable
2654@kindex dis
2655@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2656Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2657listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2658options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2659case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2660@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2661
2662@kindex enable breakpoints
2663@kindex enable
2664@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2665Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2666become effective once again in stopping your program.
2667
2668@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{bnums}@dots{}
2669Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2670of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2671
2672@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{bnums}@dots{}
2673Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2674deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2675@end table
2676
d4f3574e
SS
2677@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2678@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2679Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2680,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2681subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2682the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2683breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2684breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2685stepping}.)
2686
53a5351d 2687@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2688@subsection Break conditions
2689@cindex conditional breakpoints
2690@cindex breakpoint conditions
2691
2692@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2693@c in particular for a watchpoint?
2694The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2695specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2696breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2697programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2698a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2699and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2700
2701This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2702situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2703when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2704by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2705@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2706
2707Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2708since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2709it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2710and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2711one.
2712
2713Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2714your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2715that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2716format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2717unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2718that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2719program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2720breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2721conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2722purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2723(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2724
2725Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2726@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2727Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2728with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2729
c906108c
SS
2730You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2731The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2732@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2733catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2734
2735@table @code
2736@kindex condition
2737@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2738Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2739watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2740breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2741@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2742@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2743syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2744referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2745symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2746prints an error message:
2747
2748@example
2749No symbol "foo" in current context.
2750@end example
2751
2752@noindent
c906108c
SS
2753@value{GDBN} does
2754not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2755command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2756@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2757
2758@item condition @var{bnum}
2759Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2760an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2761@end table
2762
2763@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2764A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2765breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2766useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2767count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2768is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2769therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2770ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2771the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2772value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2773your program reaches it.
2774
2775@table @code
2776@kindex ignore
2777@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2778Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2779The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2780execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2781takes no action.
2782
2783To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2784a count of zero.
2785
2786When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2787breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2788@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2789Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2790
2791If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2792condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2793@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2794
2795You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2796as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2797is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2798variables}.
2799@end table
2800
2801Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2802
2803
53a5351d 2804@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
2805@subsection Breakpoint command lists
2806
2807@cindex breakpoint commands
2808You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2809commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2810example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2811enable other breakpoints.
2812
2813@table @code
2814@kindex commands
2815@kindex end
2816@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2817@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2818@itemx end
2819Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2820themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2821@code{end} to terminate the commands.
2822
2823To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2824follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2825
2826With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2827breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2828recently encountered).
2829@end table
2830
2831Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2832disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2833
2834You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2835use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2836that resumes execution.
2837
2838Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2839execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2840(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2841another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2842ambiguities about which list to execute.
2843
2844@kindex silent
2845If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2846usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2847be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2848then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2849see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2850meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2851
2852The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2853print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
2854breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
2855
2856For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
2857value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
2858
2859@example
2860break foo if x>0
2861commands
2862silent
2863printf "x is %d\n",x
2864cont
2865end
2866@end example
2867
2868One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
2869you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
2870of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
2871erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
2872to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
2873so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
2874command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
2875
2876@example
2877break 403
2878commands
2879silent
2880set x = y + 4
2881cont
2882end
2883@end example
2884
53a5351d 2885@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
2886@subsection Breakpoint menus
2887@cindex overloading
2888@cindex symbol overloading
2889
2890Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
2891to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
2892This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
2893@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
2894a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
2895something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
2896particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
2897you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
2898waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
2899options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
2900sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
2901@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
2902breakpoints.
2903
2904For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
2905breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
2906We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
2907
2908@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
2909@smallexample
2910@group
2911(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
2912[0] cancel
2913[1] all
2914[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
2915[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
2916[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
2917[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
2918[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
2919[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
2920> 2 4 6
2921Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
2922Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
2923Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
2924Multiple breakpoints were set.
2925Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
2926 breakpoints.
2927(@value{GDBP})
2928@end group
2929@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2930
2931@c @ifclear BARETARGET
d4f3574e
SS
2932@node Error in Breakpoints
2933@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2934@c
2935@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
2936@c
d4f3574e
SS
2937Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
2938any other process is running that program. In this situation,
2939attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
2940@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
2941
2942@example
2943Cannot insert breakpoints.
2944The same program may be running in another process.
2945@end example
2946
2947When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
2948
2949@enumerate
2950@item
2951Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
2952
2953@item
2954Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
2955name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
2956that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
2957Then start your program again.
2958
2959@item
2960Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
2961linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
2962to nonsharable executables.
2963@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
2964@c @end ifclear
2965
d4f3574e
SS
2966A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
2967hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
2968
2969@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
2970@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
2971@smallexample
2972Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
2973You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
2974@end smallexample
2975
2976@noindent
2977This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
2978only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
2979watchpoints it needs to insert.
2980
2981When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
2982hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
2983
2984
53a5351d 2985@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
2986@section Continuing and stepping
2987
2988@cindex stepping
2989@cindex continuing
2990@cindex resuming execution
2991@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
2992completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
2993one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
2994line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
2995particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
2996your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
2997it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
2998@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2999
3000@table @code
3001@kindex continue
3002@kindex c
3003@kindex fg
3004@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3005@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3006@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3007Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3008any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3009@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3010ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3011@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3012
3013The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3014stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3015@code{continue} is ignored.
3016
d4f3574e
SS
3017The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3018debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3019purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3020@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3021@end table
3022
3023To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3024(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3025calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3026different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3027
3028A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3029(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3030beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3031is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3032and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3033interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3034
3035@table @code
3036@kindex step
3037@kindex s
3038@item step
3039Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3040line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3041abbreviated @code{s}.
3042
3043@quotation
3044@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3045@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3046@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3047@c distinction here.
3048@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3049within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3050execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3051debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3052is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3053without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3054below.
3055@end quotation
3056
d4f3574e
SS
3057The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3058source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3059switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3060function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3061In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3062within the line.
c906108c 3063
d4f3574e
SS
3064Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3065number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
c906108c
SS
3066@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3067on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3068was any debugging information about the routine.
3069
3070@item step @var{count}
3071Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3072breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3073@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3074
3075@kindex next
3076@kindex n
3077@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3078Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3079This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3080the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3081control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3082that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3083is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3084
3085An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3086
3087
3088@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3089@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3090@c
3091@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3092@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3093@c function are executed without stopping.
3094
d4f3574e
SS
3095The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3096source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3097switch statements, for loops, etc.
3098
3099@kindex finish
3100@item finish
3101Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3102returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3103
3104Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3105,Returning from a function}).
3106
3107@kindex until
3108@kindex u
3109@item until
3110@itemx u
3111Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3112current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3113stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3114command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3115automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3116than the address of the jump.
3117
3118This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3119though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3120exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3121simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3122through the next iteration.
3123
3124@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3125stack frame.
3126
3127@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3128of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3129example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3130(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3131@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3132
3133@example
3134(@value{GDBP}) f
3135#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3136206 expand_input();
3137(@value{GDBP}) until
3138195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3139@end example
3140
3141This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3142generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3143start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3144written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3145to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3146expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3147statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3148
3149@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3150instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3151argument.
3152
3153@item until @var{location}
3154@itemx u @var{location}
3155Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3156reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3157the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3158,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3159and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3160
3161@kindex stepi
3162@kindex si
3163@item stepi
3164@itemx si
3165Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3166
3167It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3168instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3169instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3170Display,, Automatic display}.
3171
3172An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3173
3174@need 750
3175@kindex nexti
3176@kindex ni
3177@item nexti
3178@itemx ni
3179Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3180proceed until the function returns.
3181
3182An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3183@end table
3184
53a5351d 3185@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3186@section Signals
3187@cindex signals
3188
3189A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3190operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3191kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3192signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3193@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3194memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3195the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3196requested an alarm).
3197
3198@cindex fatal signals
3199Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3200functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3201errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3202program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3203@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3204fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3205
3206@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3207program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3208signal.
3209
3210@cindex handling signals
3211Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3212(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3213but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3214You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3215
3216@table @code
3217@kindex info signals
3218@item info signals
3219Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3220handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3221the defined types of signals.
3222
d4f3574e 3223@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3224
3225@kindex handle
3226@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3227Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3228be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3229beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3230@end table
3231
3232@c @group
3233The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3234Their full names are:
3235
3236@table @code
3237@item nostop
3238@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3239still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3240
3241@item stop
3242@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3243the @code{print} keyword as well.
3244
3245@item print
3246@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3247
3248@item noprint
3249@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3250implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3251
3252@item pass
3253@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3254can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3255and not handled.
3256
3257@item nopass
3258@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3259@end table
3260@c @end group
3261
d4f3574e
SS
3262When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3263program until you
c906108c
SS
3264continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3265effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3266after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3267command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3268program sees that signal when you continue.
3269
3270You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3271seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3272or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3273due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3274values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3275execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3276a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3277you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3278program a signal}.
c906108c 3279
53a5351d 3280@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3281@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3282
3283When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3284programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3285breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3286
3287@table @code
3288@cindex breakpoints and threads
3289@cindex thread breakpoints
3290@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3291@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3292@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3293@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3294writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3295
3296Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3297to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3298particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3299numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3300column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3301
3302If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3303breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3304program.
3305
3306You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3307well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3308breakpoint condition, like this:
3309
3310@smallexample
3311(gdb) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3312@end smallexample
3313
3314@end table
3315
3316@cindex stopped threads
3317@cindex threads, stopped
3318Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3319@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3320allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3321switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3322underfoot.
3323
3324@cindex continuing threads
3325@cindex threads, continuing
3326Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3327executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3328like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3329
3330In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3331Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3332system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3333execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3334single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3335statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3336stops.
3337
3338You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3339continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3340thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3341first thread completes whatever you requested.
3342
3343On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3344thread to run.
3345
3346@table @code
3347@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3348Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3349locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3350current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3351mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3352``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3353stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3354when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3355function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3356like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c
SS
3357thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3358GDB prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3359
3360@item show scheduler-locking
3361Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3362@end table
3363
c906108c 3364
53a5351d 3365@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3366@chapter Examining the Stack
3367
3368When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3369stopped and how it got there.
3370
3371@cindex call stack
3372Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3373is generated.
3374That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3375the arguments of the call,
3376and the local variables of the function being called.
3377The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3378The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3379stack}.
3380
3381When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3382stack allow you to see all of this information.
3383
3384@cindex selected frame
3385One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3386@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3387particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3388your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3389special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3390interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3391
3392When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3393currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3394@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3395
3396@menu
3397* Frames:: Stack frames
3398* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3399* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3400* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3401
3402@end menu
3403
53a5351d 3404@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3405@section Stack frames
3406
d4f3574e 3407@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3408@cindex stack frame
3409The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3410frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3411with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3412to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3413which the function is executing.
3414
3415@cindex initial frame
3416@cindex outermost frame
3417@cindex innermost frame
3418When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3419function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3420@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3421made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3422is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3423the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3424actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3425recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3426
3427@cindex frame pointer
3428Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3429stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3430kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3431address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3432in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3433going on in that frame.
3434
3435@cindex frame number
3436@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3437zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3438and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3439they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3440frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3441
3442@c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3443@cindex frameless execution
3444Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3445without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3446@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3447This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3448the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3449with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3450has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3451it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3452correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3453no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3454
3455@table @code
d4f3574e 3456@kindex frame@r{, command}
c906108c
SS
3457@item frame @var{args}
3458The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3459and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3460address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3461@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3462
3463@kindex select-frame
3464@item select-frame
3465The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3466to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3467@code{frame}.
3468@end table
3469
53a5351d 3470@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3471@section Backtraces
3472
3473@cindex backtraces
3474@cindex tracebacks
3475@cindex stack traces
3476A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3477line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3478frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3479stack.
3480
3481@table @code
3482@kindex backtrace
3483@kindex bt
3484@item backtrace
3485@itemx bt
3486Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3487frames in the stack.
3488
3489You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3490character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3491
3492@item backtrace @var{n}
3493@itemx bt @var{n}
3494Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3495
3496@item backtrace -@var{n}
3497@itemx bt -@var{n}
3498Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3499@end table
3500
3501@kindex where
3502@kindex info stack
3503@kindex info s
3504The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3505are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3506
3507Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3508The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3509print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3510line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3511counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3512line number.
3513
3514Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3515@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3516
3517@smallexample
3518@group
3519#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3520 at builtin.c:993
3521#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3522#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3523 at macro.c:71
3524(More stack frames follow...)
3525@end group
3526@end smallexample
3527
3528@noindent
3529The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3530value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3531code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3532
53a5351d 3533@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3534@section Selecting a frame
3535
3536Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3537whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3538selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3539of the stack frame just selected.
3540
3541@table @code
d4f3574e 3542@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
c906108c
SS
3543@kindex f
3544@item frame @var{n}
3545@itemx f @var{n}
3546Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3547(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3548innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3549@code{main}.
3550
3551@item frame @var{addr}
3552@itemx f @var{addr}
3553Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3554chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3555impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3556addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3557switches between them.
3558
c906108c
SS
3559On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3560select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3561
3562On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3563pointer and a program counter.
3564
3565On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3566pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3567@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3568@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3569@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@kindex up
3572@item up @var{n}
3573Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3574advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3575that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3576
3577@kindex down
3578@kindex do
3579@item down @var{n}
3580Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3581advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3582that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3583abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3584@end table
3585
3586All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3587frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3588arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3589frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3590
3591@need 1000
3592For example:
3593
3594@smallexample
3595@group
3596(@value{GDBP}) up
3597#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3598 at env.c:10
359910 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3600@end group
3601@end smallexample
3602
3603After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3604prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3605@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3606
3607@table @code
3608@kindex down-silently
3609@kindex up-silently
3610@item up-silently @var{n}
3611@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3612These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3613respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3614causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3615in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3616distracting.
3617@end table
3618
53a5351d 3619@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3620@section Information about a frame
3621
3622There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3623stack frame.
3624
3625@table @code
3626@item frame
3627@itemx f
3628When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3629frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3630selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3631argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3632@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3633
3634@kindex info frame
3635@kindex info f
3636@item info frame
3637@itemx info f
3638This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3639including:
3640
3641@itemize @bullet
3642@item
3643the address of the frame
3644@item
3645the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3646@item
3647the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3648@item
3649the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3650@item
3651the address of the frame's arguments
3652@item
d4f3574e
SS
3653the address of the frame's local variables
3654@item
c906108c
SS
3655the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3656@item
3657which registers were saved in the frame
3658@end itemize
3659
3660@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3661something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3662the usual conventions.
3663
3664@item info frame @var{addr}
3665@itemx info f @var{addr}
3666Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3667selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3668command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3669architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3670@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3671
3672@kindex info args
3673@item info args
3674Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3675
3676@item info locals
3677@kindex info locals
3678Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3679line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3680accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3681
c906108c 3682@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3683@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3684@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3685@item info catch
3686Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3687current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3688exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3689@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3690@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3691
c906108c
SS
3692@end table
3693
c906108c 3694
53a5351d 3695@node Source
c906108c
SS
3696@chapter Examining Source Files
3697
3698@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3699information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3700used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3701the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3702(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3703execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3704source files by explicit command.
3705
7a292a7a 3706If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3707prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3708@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3709
3710@menu
3711* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3712* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3713* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3714* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3715@end menu
3716
53a5351d 3717@node List
c906108c
SS
3718@section Printing source lines
3719
3720@kindex list
3721@kindex l
3722To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3723(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3724There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3725
3726Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3727
3728@table @code
3729@item list @var{linenum}
3730Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3731current source file.
3732
3733@item list @var{function}
3734Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3735@var{function}.
3736
3737@item list
3738Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3739@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3740printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3741as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3742Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3743
3744@item list -
3745Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3746@end table
3747
3748By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3749the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3750
3751@table @code
3752@kindex set listsize
3753@item set listsize @var{count}
3754Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3755the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3756
3757@kindex show listsize
3758@item show listsize
3759Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3760@end table
3761
3762Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3763so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3764than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3765argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3766each repetition moves up in the source file.
3767
3768@cindex linespec
3769In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3770@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 3771of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
3772Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3773
3774@table @code
3775@item list @var{linespec}
3776Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3777
3778@item list @var{first},@var{last}
3779Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3780linespecs.
3781
3782@item list ,@var{last}
3783Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3784
3785@item list @var{first},
3786Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3787
3788@item list +
3789Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3790
3791@item list -
3792Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3793
3794@item list
3795As described in the preceding table.
3796@end table
3797
3798Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3799kinds of linespec.
3800
3801@table @code
3802@item @var{number}
3803Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3804When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3805the same source file as the first linespec.
3806
3807@item +@var{offset}
3808Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3809When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3810two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3811first linespec.
3812
3813@item -@var{offset}
3814Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3815
3816@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3817Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3818
3819@item @var{function}
3820Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3821For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3822
3823@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3824Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3825function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3826file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3827identically named functions in different source files.
3828
3829@item *@var{address}
3830Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3831@var{address} may be any expression.
3832@end table
3833
53a5351d 3834@node Search
c906108c
SS
3835@section Searching source files
3836@cindex searching
3837@kindex reverse-search
3838
3839There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3840regular expression.
3841
3842@table @code
3843@kindex search
3844@kindex forward-search
3845@item forward-search @var{regexp}
3846@itemx search @var{regexp}
3847The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3848starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3849@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3850synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3851@code{fo}.
3852
3853@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
3854The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
3855with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
3856for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
3857this command as @code{rev}.
3858@end table
c906108c 3859
53a5351d 3860@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
3861@section Specifying source directories
3862
3863@cindex source path
3864@cindex directories for source files
3865Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
3866files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
3867the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
3868session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
3869this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
3870it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
3871in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
3872the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
3873the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
3874path.
3875
3876If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
3877object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
3878too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
3879compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
3880last resort.
3881
3882Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
3883any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
3884each line is in the file.
3885
3886@kindex directory
3887@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
3888When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
3889and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
3890To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
3891
3892@table @code
3893@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
3894@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
3895Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
3896directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
3897(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
3898part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
3899whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
3900path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
3901
3902@kindex cdir
3903@kindex cwd
3904@kindex $cdir
3905@kindex $cwd
3906@cindex compilation directory
3907@cindex current directory
3908@cindex working directory
3909@cindex directory, current
3910@cindex directory, compilation
3911You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
3912directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
3913working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
3914tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
3915session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
3916directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
3917
3918@item directory
3919Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
3920
3921@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
3922@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
3923
3924@item show directories
3925@kindex show directories
3926Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
3927@end table
3928
3929If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
3930interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
3931versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
3932
3933@enumerate
3934@item
3935Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
3936
3937@item
3938Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
3939directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
3940directories in one command.
3941@end enumerate
3942
53a5351d 3943@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
3944@section Source and machine code
3945
3946You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
3947addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
3948a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 3949mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
c906108c
SS
3950line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
3951well as hex.
3952
3953@table @code
3954@kindex info line
3955@item info line @var{linespec}
3956Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
3957source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
3958the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
3959source lines}).
3960@end table
3961
3962For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
3963the object code for the first line of function
3964@code{m4_changequote}:
3965
d4f3574e
SS
3966@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
3967@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c
SS
3968@smallexample
3969(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
3970Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
3971@end smallexample
3972
3973@noindent
3974We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
3975@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
3976@smallexample
3977(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
3978Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
3979@end smallexample
3980
3981@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
d4f3574e 3982@kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
c906108c
SS
3983After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
3984is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
3985sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
3986,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
3987convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3988variables}).
3989
3990@table @code
3991@kindex disassemble
3992@cindex assembly instructions
3993@cindex instructions, assembly
3994@cindex machine instructions
3995@cindex listing machine instructions
3996@item disassemble
3997This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
3998instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
3999program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4000command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4001surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4002(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4003@end table
4004
c906108c
SS
4005The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4006HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4007
4008@smallexample
4009(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4010Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
40110x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
40120x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
40130x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
40140x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
40150x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
40160x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
40170x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
40180x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4019End of assembler dump.
4020@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4021
4022Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4023mnemonics or other syntax.
4024
4025@table @code
d4f3574e 4026@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4027@cindex assembly instructions
4028@cindex instructions, assembly
4029@cindex machine instructions
4030@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4031@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4032@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4033@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4034Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4035program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4036
4037Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4038can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4039The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4040assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4041@end table
4042
4043
53a5351d 4044@node Data
c906108c
SS
4045@chapter Examining Data
4046
4047@cindex printing data
4048@cindex examining data
4049@kindex print
4050@kindex inspect
4051@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4052@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4053@c different window or something like that.
4054The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4055command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4056evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4057program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4058Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4059
4060@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4061@item print @var{expr}
4062@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4063@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4064value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4065you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4066@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4067formats}.
4068
4069@item print
4070@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4071If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4072@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4073conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4074@end table
4075
4076A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4077It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4078specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4079
7a292a7a 4080If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4081fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4082command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4083Table}.
c906108c
SS
4084
4085@menu
4086* Expressions:: Expressions
4087* Variables:: Program variables
4088* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4089* Output Formats:: Output formats
4090* Memory:: Examining memory
4091* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4092* Print Settings:: Print settings
4093* Value History:: Value history
4094* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4095* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4096* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4097@end menu
4098
53a5351d 4099@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4100@section Expressions
4101
4102@cindex expressions
4103@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4104compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4105by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4106@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4107and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4108by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4109
d4f3574e
SS
4110@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4111the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4112you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4113memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4114
c906108c
SS
4115Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4116this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4117Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4118languages.
4119
4120In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4121expressions regardless of your programming language.
4122
4123Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4124useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4125at that address in memory.
4126@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4127
4128@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4129to programming languages:
4130
4131@table @code
4132@item @@
4133@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4134@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4135
4136@item ::
4137@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4138function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4139
4140@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4141@cindex type casting memory
4142@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4143@cindex casts, to view memory
4144@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4145Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4146memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4147pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4148a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4149normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4150@end table
4151
53a5351d 4152@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4153@section Program variables
4154
4155The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4156in your program.
4157
4158Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4159(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4160
4161@itemize @bullet
4162@item
4163global (or file-static)
4164@end itemize
4165
4166@noindent or
4167
4168@itemize @bullet
4169@item
4170visible according to the scope rules of the
4171programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4172@end itemize
4173
4174@noindent This means that in the function
4175
4176@example
4177foo (a)
4178 int a;
4179@{
4180 bar (a);
4181 @{
4182 int b = test ();
4183 bar (b);
4184 @}
4185@}
4186@end example
4187
4188@noindent
4189you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4190executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4191examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4192the block where @code{b} is declared.
4193
4194@cindex variable name conflict
4195There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4196scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4197in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4198function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4199happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4200you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4201using the colon-colon notation:
4202
d4f3574e 4203@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4204@iftex
4205@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4206@kindex ::
4207@end iftex
4208@example
4209@var{file}::@var{variable}
4210@var{function}::@var{variable}
4211@end example
4212
4213@noindent
4214Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4215static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4216make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4217to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4218
4219@example
4220(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4221@end example
4222
c906108c
SS
4223@cindex C++ scope resolution
4224This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4225use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4226scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4227@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4228@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4229
4230@cindex wrong values
4231@cindex variable values, wrong
4232@quotation
4233@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4234wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4235scope, and just before exit.
4236@end quotation
4237You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4238This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4239set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4240stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4241values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4242also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4243after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4244variable definitions may be gone.
4245
4246This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4247To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4248when compiling.
4249
d4f3574e
SS
4250@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4251Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4252unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4253opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4254offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4255might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4256happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4257
4258@example
4259No symbol "foo" in current context.
4260@end example
4261
4262To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4263different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4264formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4265supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4266in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4267to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4268debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4269Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4270information.
4271
4272
53a5351d 4273@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4274@section Artificial arrays
4275
4276@cindex artificial array
4277@kindex @@
4278It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4279same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4280dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4281program.
4282
4283You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4284@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4285operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4286and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4287of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4288the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4289argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4290following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4291example. If a program says
4292
4293@example
4294int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4295@end example
4296
4297@noindent
4298you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4299
4300@example
4301p *array@@len
4302@end example
4303
4304The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4305with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4306subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4307Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4308(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4309
4310Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4311This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4312The value need not be in memory:
4313@example
4314(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4315$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4316@end example
4317
4318As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
d4f3574e 4319@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) gdb calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4320the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4321@example
4322(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4323$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4324@end example
4325
4326Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4327moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4328actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4329of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4330to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4331variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4332interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4333instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4334structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4335in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4336
4337@example
4338set $i = 0
4339p dtab[$i++]->fv
4340@key{RET}
4341@key{RET}
4342@dots{}
4343@end example
4344
53a5351d 4345@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4346@section Output formats
4347
4348@cindex formatted output
4349@cindex output formats
4350By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4351this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4352in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4353at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4354these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4355
4356The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4357already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4358@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4359letters supported are:
4360
4361@table @code
4362@item x
4363Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4364hexadecimal.
4365
4366@item d
4367Print as integer in signed decimal.
4368
4369@item u
4370Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4371
4372@item o
4373Print as integer in octal.
4374
4375@item t
4376Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4377@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4378used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4379see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4380
4381@item a
4382@cindex unknown address, locating
4383Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4384the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4385where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4386
4387@example
4388(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4389$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4390@end example
4391
4392@item c
4393Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4394
4395@item f
4396Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4397using typical floating point syntax.
4398@end table
4399
4400For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4401
4402@example
4403p/x $pc
4404@end example
4405
4406@noindent
4407Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4408names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4409
4410To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4411you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4412expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4413
53a5351d 4414@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4415@section Examining memory
4416
4417You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4418any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4419
4420@cindex examining memory
4421@table @code
4422@kindex x
4423@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4424@itemx x @var{addr}
4425@itemx x
4426Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4427@end table
4428
4429@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4430much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4431expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4432If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4433Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4434
4435@table @r
4436@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4437The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4438how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4439@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4440@c 4.1.2.
4441
4442@item @var{f}, the display format
4443The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4444@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4445The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4446The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4447
4448@item @var{u}, the unit size
4449The unit size is any of
4450
4451@table @code
4452@item b
4453Bytes.
4454@item h
4455Halfwords (two bytes).
4456@item w
4457Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4458@item g
4459Giant words (eight bytes).
4460@end table
4461
4462Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4463default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4464@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4465
4466@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4467@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4468memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4469it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4470@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4471@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4472other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4473the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4474starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4475a value from memory).
4476@end table
4477
4478For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4479(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4480starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4481words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4482@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4483
4484Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4485letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4486unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4487specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4488(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4489
4490Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4491and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4492@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4493including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4494alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4495Code,,Source and machine code}.
4496
4497All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4498easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4499you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4500instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4501with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4502the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4503for successive uses of @code{x}.
4504
4505@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4506The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4507in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4508would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4509subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4510@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4511examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4512@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4513the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4514
4515If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4516are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4517address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4518
53a5351d 4519@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4520@section Automatic display
4521@cindex automatic display
4522@cindex display of expressions
4523
4524If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4525(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4526display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4527Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4528to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4529The automatic display looks like this:
4530
4531@example
45322: foo = 38
45333: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4534@end example
4535
4536@noindent
4537This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4538displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4539specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4540whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4541format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4542or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4543supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4544
4545@table @code
4546@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4547@item display @var{expr}
4548Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4549each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4550
4551@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4552
d4f3574e 4553@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4554For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4555count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4556arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4557@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4558
4559@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4560For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4561number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4562be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4563doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4564@end table
4565
4566For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4567instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4568is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4569
4570@table @code
4571@kindex delete display
4572@kindex undisplay
4573@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4574@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4575Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4576
4577@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4578(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4579
4580@kindex disable display
4581@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4582Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4583item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4584enabled again later.
4585
4586@kindex enable display
4587@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4588Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4589again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4590
4591@item display
4592Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4593done when your program stops.
4594
4595@kindex info display
4596@item info display
4597Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4598automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4599values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4600It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4601because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4602@end table
4603
4604If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4605sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4606expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4607variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4608@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4609@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4610continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4611there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4612automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4613is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4614
53a5351d 4615@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4616@section Print settings
4617
4618@cindex format options
4619@cindex print settings
4620@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4621and symbols are printed.
4622
4623@noindent
4624These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4625
4626@table @code
4627@kindex set print address
4628@item set print address
4629@itemx set print address on
4630@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4631traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4632even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4633is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4634@code{set print address on}:
4635
4636@smallexample
4637@group
4638(@value{GDBP}) f
4639#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4640 at input.c:530
4641530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4642@end group
4643@end smallexample
4644
4645@item set print address off
4646Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4647this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4648
4649@smallexample
4650@group
4651(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4652(@value{GDBP}) f
4653#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4654530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4655@end group
4656@end smallexample
4657
4658You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4659dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4660@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4661all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4662
4663@kindex show print address
4664@item show print address
4665Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4666@end table
4667
4668When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4669closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4670identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4671source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4672@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4673you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4674it prints a symbolic address:
4675
4676@table @code
4677@kindex set print symbol-filename
4678@item set print symbol-filename on
4679Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4680symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4681
4682@item set print symbol-filename off
4683Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4684default.
4685
4686@kindex show print symbol-filename
4687@item show print symbol-filename
4688Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4689line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4690@end table
4691
4692Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4693numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4694number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4695
4696Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4697printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4698
4699@table @code
4700@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4701@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4702Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4703offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4704@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4705to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4706
4707@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4708@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4709Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4710symbolic address.
4711@end table
4712
4713@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4714@cindex pointer, finding referent
4715If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4716@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4717and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4718@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4719For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4720at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4721
4722@example
4723(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4724(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4725$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4726@end example
4727
4728@quotation
4729@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4730does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4731the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4732@end quotation
4733
4734Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4735
4736@table @code
4737@kindex set print array
4738@item set print array
4739@itemx set print array on
4740Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4741but uses more space. The default is off.
4742
4743@item set print array off
4744Return to compressed format for arrays.
4745
4746@kindex show print array
4747@item show print array
4748Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4749arrays.
4750
4751@kindex set print elements
4752@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4753Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4754If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4755printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4756This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4757When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4758Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4759
4760@kindex show print elements
4761@item show print elements
4762Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4763If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4764
4765@kindex set print null-stop
4766@item set print null-stop
4767Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 4768@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 4769contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 4770The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4771
4772@kindex set print pretty
4773@item set print pretty on
4774Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4775per line, like this:
4776
4777@smallexample
4778@group
4779$1 = @{
4780 next = 0x0,
4781 flags = @{
4782 sweet = 1,
4783 sour = 1
4784 @},
4785 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4786@}
4787@end group
4788@end smallexample
4789
4790@item set print pretty off
4791Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4792
4793@smallexample
4794@group
4795$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4796meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4797@end group
4798@end smallexample
4799
4800@noindent
4801This is the default format.
4802
4803@kindex show print pretty
4804@item show print pretty
4805Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4806
4807@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4808@item set print sevenbit-strings on
4809Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4810@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4811character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4812best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4813high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4814
4815@item set print sevenbit-strings off
4816Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4817international character sets, and is the default.
4818
4819@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4820@item show print sevenbit-strings
4821Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4822
4823@kindex set print union
4824@item set print union on
4825Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4826is the default setting.
4827
4828@item set print union off
4829Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4830
4831@kindex show print union
4832@item show print union
4833Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4834structures.
4835
4836For example, given the declarations
4837
4838@smallexample
4839typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4840typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4841typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4842 Bug_forms;
4843
4844struct thing @{
4845 Species it;
4846 union @{
4847 Tree_forms tree;
4848 Bug_forms bug;
4849 @} form;
4850@};
4851
4852struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4853@end smallexample
4854
4855@noindent
4856with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
4857
4858@smallexample
4859$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
4860@end smallexample
4861
4862@noindent
4863and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
4864
4865@smallexample
4866$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
4867@end smallexample
4868@end table
4869
c906108c
SS
4870@need 1000
4871@noindent
4872These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
4873
4874@table @code
4875@cindex demangling
4876@kindex set print demangle
4877@item set print demangle
4878@itemx set print demangle on
4879Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
4880(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 4881linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
4882
4883@kindex show print demangle
4884@item show print demangle
4885Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
4886
4887@kindex set print asm-demangle
4888@item set print asm-demangle
4889@itemx set print asm-demangle on
4890Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
4891in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
4892The default is off.
4893
4894@kindex show print asm-demangle
4895@item show print asm-demangle
4896Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
4897or demangled form.
4898
4899@kindex set demangle-style
4900@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
4901@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
4902@item set demangle-style @var{style}
4903Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
4904represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
4905
4906@table @code
4907@item auto
4908Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
4909
4910@item gnu
4911Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 4912This is the default.
c906108c
SS
4913
4914@item hp
4915Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
4916
4917@item lucid
4918Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
4919
4920@item arm
4921Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
4922@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
4923debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
4924require further enhancement to permit that.
4925
4926@end table
4927If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
4928
4929@kindex show demangle-style
4930@item show demangle-style
4931Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
4932
4933@kindex set print object
4934@item set print object
4935@itemx set print object on
4936When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
4937(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
4938the virtual function table.
4939
4940@item set print object off
4941Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
4942virtual function table. This is the default setting.
4943
4944@kindex show print object
4945@item show print object
4946Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
4947
4948@kindex set print static-members
4949@item set print static-members
4950@itemx set print static-members on
4951Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
4952
4953@item set print static-members off
4954Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
4955
4956@kindex show print static-members
4957@item show print static-members
4958Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
4959
4960@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
4961@kindex set print vtbl
4962@item set print vtbl
4963@itemx set print vtbl on
4964Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4965(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
4966ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
4967
4968@item set print vtbl off
4969Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
4970
4971@kindex show print vtbl
4972@item show print vtbl
4973Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
4974@end table
c906108c 4975
53a5351d 4976@node Value History
c906108c
SS
4977@section Value history
4978
4979@cindex value history
4980Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
4981@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
4982Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
4983(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
4984When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
4985since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
4986symbol table.
4987
4988@cindex @code{$}
4989@cindex @code{$$}
4990@cindex history number
4991The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
4992refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
4993@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
4994printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
4995history number.
4996
4997To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
4998history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
4999remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5000the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5001@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5002is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5003@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5004
5005For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5006want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5007
5008@example
5009p *$
5010@end example
5011
5012If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5013to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5014
5015@example
5016p *$.next
5017@end example
5018
5019@noindent
5020You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5021command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5022
5023Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5024@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5025
5026@example
5027print x
5028set x=5
5029@end example
5030
5031@noindent
5032then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5033remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5034
5035@table @code
5036@kindex show values
5037@item show values
5038Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5039This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5040values} does not change the history.
5041
5042@item show values @var{n}
5043Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5044
5045@item show values +
5046Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5047values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5048@end table
5049
5050Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5051same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5052
53a5351d 5053@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5054@section Convenience variables
5055
5056@cindex convenience variables
5057@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5058@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5059exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5060setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5061of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5062
5063Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5064@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5065the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5066(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5067by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5068
5069You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5070expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5071For example:
5072
5073@example
5074set $foo = *object_ptr
5075@end example
5076
5077@noindent
5078would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5079@code{object_ptr}.
5080
5081Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5082value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5083value with another assignment at any time.
5084
5085Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5086variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5087that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5088variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5089
5090@table @code
5091@kindex show convenience
5092@item show convenience
5093Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5094Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5095@end table
5096
5097One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5098incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5099a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5100
5101@example
5102set $i = 0
5103print bar[$i++]->contents
5104@end example
5105
d4f3574e
SS
5106@noindent
5107Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5108
5109Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5110values likely to be useful.
5111
5112@table @code
5113@kindex $_
5114@item $_
5115The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5116the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5117commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5118set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5119and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5120except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5121to the type of @code{$__}.
5122
5123@kindex $__
5124@item $__
5125The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5126to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5127to match the format in which the data was printed.
5128
5129@item $_exitcode
5130@kindex $_exitcode
5131The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5132the program being debugged terminates.
5133@end table
5134
53a5351d
JM
5135On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5136begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5137name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5138
53a5351d 5139@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5140@section Registers
5141
5142@cindex registers
5143You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5144with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5145for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5146your machine.
5147
5148@table @code
5149@kindex info registers
5150@item info registers
5151Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5152registers (in the selected stack frame).
5153
5154@kindex info all-registers
5155@cindex floating point registers
5156@item info all-registers
5157Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5158registers.
5159
5160@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5161Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5162As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5163the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5164the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5165@end table
5166
5167@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5168expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5169architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5170@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5171the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5172pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5173register that contains the processor status. For example,
5174you could print the program counter in hex with
5175
5176@example
5177p/x $pc
5178@end example
5179
5180@noindent
5181or print the instruction to be executed next with
5182
5183@example
5184x/i $pc
5185@end example
5186
5187@noindent
5188or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5189one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5190memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5191stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5192stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5193regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5194see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5195
5196@example
5197set $sp += 4
5198@end example
5199
5200Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5201your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5202so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5203shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5204registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5205can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5206is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5207
5208@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5209integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5210special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5211registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5212to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5213(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5214@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5215
5216Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5217means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5218the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5219sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5220coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5221programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5222cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5223that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5224prints the data in both formats.
5225
5226Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5227(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5228value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5229were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5230true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5231frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5232
5233However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5234code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5235@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5236frame makes no difference.
5237
53a5351d 5238@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5239@section Floating point hardware
5240@cindex floating point
5241
5242Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5243you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5244
5245@table @code
5246@kindex info float
5247@item info float
5248Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5249point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5250floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5251the ARM and x86 machines.
5252@end table
c906108c 5253
53a5351d 5254@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5255@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5256@cindex languages
5257
c906108c
SS
5258Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5259rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5260dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5261Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5262represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5263@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5264
5265@cindex working language
5266Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5267allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5268native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5269consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5270language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5271language}.
5272
5273@menu
5274* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5275* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5276* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5277* Support:: Supported languages
5278@end menu
5279
53a5351d 5280@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5281@section Switching between source languages
5282
5283There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5284set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5285@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5286defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5287used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5288are printed, etc.
5289
5290In addition to the working language, every source file that
5291@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5292file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5293source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5294language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5295controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5296show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5297set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5298set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5299Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5300
5301This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5302as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5303another language. In that case, make the
5304program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5305@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5306program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5307
5308@menu
5309* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5310* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5311* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5312@end menu
5313
53a5351d 5314@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5315@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5316
5317If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5318@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5319
5320@table @file
5321
5322@item .c
5323C source file
5324
5325@item .C
5326@itemx .cc
5327@itemx .cp
5328@itemx .cpp
5329@itemx .cxx
5330@itemx .c++
5331C++ source file
5332
5333@item .f
5334@itemx .F
5335Fortran source file
5336
c906108c
SS
5337@item .ch
5338@itemx .c186
5339@itemx .c286
5340CHILL source file.
c906108c 5341
c906108c
SS
5342@item .mod
5343Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5344
5345@item .s
5346@itemx .S
5347Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5348@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5349@end table
5350
5351In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5352extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5353
53a5351d 5354@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5355@subsection Setting the working language
5356
5357If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5358expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5359your program.
5360
5361@kindex set language
5362If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5363command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5364a language, such as
c906108c 5365@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5366For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5367
c906108c
SS
5368Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5369language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5370to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5371source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5372languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5373source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5374command such as:
5375
5376@example
5377print a = b + c
5378@end example
5379
5380@noindent
5381might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5382@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5383printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5384@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5385
53a5351d 5386@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5387@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5388
5389To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5390@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5391then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5392frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5393working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5394frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5395or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5396does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5397not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5398
5399This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5400entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5401written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5402a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5403case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5404
53a5351d 5405@node Show
c906108c 5406@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5407
5408The following commands help you find out which language is the
5409working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5410
5411@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5412@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5413@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5414@table @code
5415@item show language
5416Display the current working language. This is the
5417language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5418build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5419
5420@item info frame
5421Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5422working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5423@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5424information listed here.
5425
5426@item info source
5427Display the source language of this source file.
5428@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5429information listed here.
5430@end table
5431
5432In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5433not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5434with a language explicitly:
5435
5436@kindex set extension-language
5437@kindex info extensions
5438@table @code
5439@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5440Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5441the source language @var{language}.
5442
5443@item info extensions
5444List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5445@end table
5446
53a5351d 5447@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5448@section Type and range checking
5449
5450@quotation
5451@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5452checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5453section documents the intended facilities.
5454@end quotation
5455@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5456
5457Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5458errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5459checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5460sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5461these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5462by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5463errors when your program is running.
5464
5465@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5466Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5467can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5468the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5469@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5470your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5471for the default settings of supported languages.
5472
5473@menu
5474* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5475* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5476@end menu
5477
5478@cindex type checking
5479@cindex checks, type
53a5351d 5480@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5481@subsection An overview of type checking
5482
5483Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5484arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5485otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5486errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5487
5488@smallexample
54891 + 2 @result{} 3
5490@exdent but
5491@error{} 1 + 2.3
5492@end smallexample
5493
5494The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5495type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5496
5497For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5498@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5499to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5500or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5501but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5502these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5503also issues a warning.
5504
5505Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5506related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5507For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5508a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5509with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5510the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5511
5512Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5513instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5514operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5515represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5516operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5517details on specific languages.
5518
5519@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5520
d4f3574e 5521@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5522@kindex set check type
5523@kindex show check type
5524@table @code
5525@item set check type auto
5526Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5527@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5528each language.
5529
5530@item set check type on
5531@itemx set check type off
5532Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5533current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5534match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5535evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5536message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5537
5538@item set check type warn
5539Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5540evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5541be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5542numbers and structures.
5543
5544@item show type
5545Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5546is setting it automatically.
5547@end table
5548
5549@cindex range checking
5550@cindex checks, range
53a5351d 5551@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5552@subsection An overview of range checking
5553
5554In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5555bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5556checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5557computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5558not exceed the bounds of the array.
5559
5560For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5561@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5562always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5563warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5564
5565A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5566array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5567of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5568error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5569result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5570the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5571
5572@example
5573@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5574@end example
5575
5576This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5577specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5578Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5579
5580@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5581
d4f3574e 5582@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5583@kindex set check range
5584@kindex show check range
5585@table @code
5586@item set check range auto
5587Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5588@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5589each language.
5590
5591@item set check range on
5592@itemx set check range off
5593Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5594current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5595match the language default. If a range error occurs, then a message
5596is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5597
5598@item set check range warn
5599Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5600but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5601expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5602memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5603systems).
5604
5605@item show range
5606Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5607being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5608@end table
c906108c 5609
53a5351d 5610@node Support
c906108c 5611@section Supported languages
c906108c 5612
cce74817
JM
5613@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5614@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5615Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5616language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5617and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5618,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5619language.
5620
5621The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5622supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5623tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5624@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5625formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5626books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5627language reference or tutorial.
5628
c906108c 5629@menu
7a292a7a 5630* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5631* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5632* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5633@end menu
5634
53a5351d 5635@node C
c906108c 5636@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5637
c906108c
SS
5638@cindex C and C++
5639@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5640
5641Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5642to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5643together.
5644
c906108c
SS
5645@cindex C++
5646@kindex g++
5647@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5648The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5649compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5650effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5651C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5652compiler (@code{aCC}).
5653
5654For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5655format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5656command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5657@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5658CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5659
c906108c
SS
5660@menu
5661* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5662* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5663* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5664* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5665* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5666* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5667* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5668@end menu
c906108c 5669
53a5351d 5670@node C Operators
c906108c 5671@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5672
5673@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5674
5675Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5676@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5677often defined on groups of types.
5678
c906108c 5679For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5680
5681@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5682
c906108c 5683@item
c906108c
SS
5684@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5685specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5686
5687@item
d4f3574e
SS
5688@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5689@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5690
5691@item
53a5351d 5692@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5693
5694@item
5695@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5696
c906108c
SS
5697@end itemize
5698
5699@noindent
5700The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5701in order of increasing precedence:
5702
5703@table @code
5704@item ,
5705The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5706are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5707expression being the last expression evaluated.
5708
5709@item =
5710Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5711assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5712
5713@item @var{op}=
5714Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5715and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5716@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5717@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5718@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5719
5720@item ?:
5721The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5722of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5723integral type.
5724
5725@item ||
5726Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5727
5728@item &&
5729Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5730
5731@item |
5732Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5733
5734@item ^
5735Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5736
5737@item &
5738Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5739
5740@item ==@r{, }!=
5741Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5742expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5743
5744@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5745Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5746Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5747and non-zero for true.
5748
5749@item <<@r{, }>>
5750left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5751
5752@item @@
5753The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5754
5755@item +@r{, }-
5756Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5757pointer types.
5758
5759@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5760Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5761defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5762integral types.
5763
5764@item ++@r{, }--
5765Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5766operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5767when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5768operation takes place.
5769
5770@item *
5771Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5772@code{++}.
5773
5774@item &
5775Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5776
c906108c
SS
5777For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5778allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5779(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5780where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5781stored.
c906108c
SS
5782
5783@item -
5784Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5785precedence as @code{++}.
5786
5787@item !
5788Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5789@code{++}.
5790
5791@item ~
5792Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5793@code{++}.
5794
5795
5796@item .@r{, }->
5797Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5798@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5799pointer based on the stored type information.
5800Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5801
c906108c
SS
5802@item .*@r{, }->*
5803Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
5804
5805@item []
5806Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5807@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5808
5809@item ()
5810Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5811
c906108c 5812@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5813C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5814and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
5815
5816@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5817Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5818(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5819above.
c906108c
SS
5820@end table
5821
c906108c
SS
5822If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5823attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5824predefined meaning.
c906108c 5825
c906108c
SS
5826@menu
5827* C Constants::
5828@end menu
5829
53a5351d 5830@node C Constants
c906108c 5831@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
5832
5833@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 5834
7a292a7a 5835@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 5836following ways:
c906108c
SS
5837
5838@itemize @bullet
5839@item
5840Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5841specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5842a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5843@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5844@code{long} value.
5845
5846@item
5847Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5848point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5849exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5850@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5851sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
5852A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
5853@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
5854the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
5855a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
5856constant.
c906108c
SS
5857
5858@item
5859Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
5860integral equivalents.
5861
5862@item
5863Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
5864(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 5865(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
5866be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
5867the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
5868of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
5869@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
5870@samp{\n} for newline.
5871
5872@item
5873String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
5874by double quotes (@code{"}).
5875
5876@item
5877Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
5878to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
5879
5880@item
5881Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
5882and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
5883integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
5884and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
5885@end itemize
5886
c906108c 5887@menu
7a292a7a 5888* C plus plus expressions::
c906108c 5889* C Defaults::
c906108c 5890* C Checks::
c906108c
SS
5891
5892* Debugging C::
5893@end menu
5894
53a5351d 5895@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 5896@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
5897
5898@cindex expressions in C++
5899@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
5900
c906108c
SS
5901@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
5902@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
5903@cindex C++ and object formats
5904@cindex object formats and C++
5905@cindex a.out and C++
5906@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
5907@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
5908@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
5909@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
5910@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
5911@c periodically whether this has happened...
5912@quotation
5913@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
5914proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
5915additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
5916special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
5917@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
5918symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
5919you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
5920extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
5921@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
5922support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
5923@end quotation
c906108c
SS
5924
5925@enumerate
5926
5927@cindex member functions
5928@item
5929Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
5930
5931@example
5932count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
5933@end example
5934
5935@kindex this
5936@cindex namespace in C++
5937@item
5938While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
5939expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
5940that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
5941pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
5942
c906108c 5943@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 5944@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
5945@cindex type conversions in C++
5946@item
5947You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 5948call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
5949perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
5950calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
5951in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
5952default arguments.
5953
5954It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
5955promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
5956class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
5957functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
5958number of function arguments.
5959
5960Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
5961@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
5962,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
5963
d4f3574e 5964You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
5965explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
5966@smallexample
5967p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
5968@end smallexample
d4f3574e 5969
c906108c 5970The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 5971see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 5972
c906108c
SS
5973@cindex reference declarations
5974@item
5975@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
5976them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
5977dereferenced.
5978
5979In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
5980reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
5981avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
5982The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
5983you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
5984
5985@item
5986@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
5987expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
5988one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
5989necessary, for example in an expression like
5990@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
5991resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
5992debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
5993@end enumerate
5994
53a5351d
JM
5995In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
5996calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
5997objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
5998invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 5999
53a5351d 6000@node C Defaults
c906108c 6001@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6002
c906108c
SS
6003@cindex C and C++ defaults
6004
c906108c
SS
6005If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6006both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6007C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6008selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6009
6010If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6011recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6012@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6013these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6014@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6015for further details.
6016
c906108c
SS
6017@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6018@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6019@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6020
53a5351d 6021@node C Checks
c906108c 6022@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6023
c906108c
SS
6024@cindex C and C++ checks
6025
6026By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6027is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6028considers two variables type equivalent if:
6029
6030@itemize @bullet
6031@item
6032The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6033enumerated tag.
6034
6035@item
6036The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6037declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6038
6039@ignore
6040@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6041@c FIXME--beers?
6042@item
6043The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6044declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6045compilers.)
6046@end ignore
6047@end itemize
6048
6049Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6050indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6051that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6052
53a5351d 6053@node Debugging C
c906108c 6054@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6055
6056The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6057the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6058inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6059appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6060
6061The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6062with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6063,Expressions}.
6064
c906108c
SS
6065@menu
6066* Debugging C plus plus::
6067@end menu
6068
53a5351d 6069@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6070@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6071
6072@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6073
c906108c
SS
6074Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6075designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6076
6077@table @code
6078@cindex break in overloaded functions
6079@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6080When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6081@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6082you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6083
6084@cindex overloading in C++
6085@item rbreak @var{regex}
6086Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6087breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6088classes.
6089@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6090
6091@cindex C++ exception handling
6092@item catch throw
6093@itemx catch catch
6094Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6095Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6096
6097@cindex inheritance
6098@item ptype @var{typename}
6099Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6100@var{typename}.
6101@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6102
6103@cindex C++ symbol display
6104@item set print demangle
6105@itemx show print demangle
6106@itemx set print asm-demangle
6107@itemx show print asm-demangle
6108Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6109displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6110@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6111
6112@item set print object
6113@itemx show print object
6114Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6115@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6116
6117@item set print vtbl
6118@itemx show print vtbl
6119Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6120@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6121(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6122ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6123
6124@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6125@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6126@item set overload-resolution on
6127Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6128is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6129and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6130using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6131expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6132message.
6133
6134@item set overload-resolution off
6135Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6136overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6137chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6138symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6139overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6140searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6141argument types.
c906108c
SS
6142
6143@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6144You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6145the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6146@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6147also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6148available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6149@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6150@end table
c906108c 6151
53a5351d 6152@node Modula-2
c906108c 6153@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6154
d4f3574e 6155@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6156
6157The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6158output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6159developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6160attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6161to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6162table.
6163
6164@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6165@menu
6166* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6167* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6168* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6169* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6170* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6171* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6172* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6173* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6174@end menu
6175
53a5351d 6176@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6177@subsubsection Operators
6178@cindex Modula-2 operators
6179
6180Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6181@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6182often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6183following definitions hold:
6184
6185@itemize @bullet
6186
6187@item
6188@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6189their subranges.
6190
6191@item
6192@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6193
6194@item
6195@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6196
6197@item
6198@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6199@var{type}}.
6200
6201@item
6202@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6203
6204@item
6205@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6206
6207@item
6208@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6209@end itemize
6210
6211@noindent
6212The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6213increasing precedence:
6214
6215@table @code
6216@item ,
6217Function argument or array index separator.
6218
6219@item :=
6220Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6221@var{value}.
6222
6223@item <@r{, }>
6224Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6225types.
6226
6227@item <=@r{, }>=
6228Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6229on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6230set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6231
6232@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6233Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6234Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6235available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6236comment character.
6237
6238@item IN
6239Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6240Same precedence as @code{<}.
6241
6242@item OR
6243Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6244
6245@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6246Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6247
6248@item @@
6249The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6250
6251@item +@r{, }-
6252Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6253and difference on set types.
6254
6255@item *
6256Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6257on set types.
6258
6259@item /
6260Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6261types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6262
6263@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6264Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6265precedence as @code{*}.
6266
6267@item -
6268Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6269
6270@item ^
6271Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6272
6273@item NOT
6274Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6275@code{^}.
6276
6277@item .
6278@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6279precedence as @code{^}.
6280
6281@item []
6282Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6283
6284@item ()
6285Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6286as @code{^}.
6287
6288@item ::@r{, }.
6289@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6290@end table
6291
6292@quotation
6293@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6294treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6295@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6296@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6297@end quotation
6298
6299@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
53a5351d 6300@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6301@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6302
6303Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6304In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6305
6306@table @var
6307
6308@item a
6309represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6310
6311@item c
6312represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6313
6314@item i
6315represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6316
6317@item m
6318represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6319same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6320be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6321
6322@item n
6323represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6324
6325@item r
6326represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6327
6328@item t
6329represents a type.
6330
6331@item v
6332represents a variable.
6333
6334@item x
6335represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6336explanation of the function for details.
6337@end table
6338
6339All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6340
6341@table @code
6342@item ABS(@var{n})
6343Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6344
6345@item CAP(@var{c})
6346If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6347equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument
6348
6349@item CHR(@var{i})
6350Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6351
6352@item DEC(@var{v})
6353Decrements the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6354
6355@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6356Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6357new value.
6358
6359@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6360Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6361set.
6362
6363@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6364Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6365
6366@item HIGH(@var{a})
6367Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6368
6369@item INC(@var{v})
6370Increments the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6371
6372@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6373Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6374new value.
6375
6376@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6377Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6378there. Returns the new set.
6379
6380@item MAX(@var{t})
6381Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6382
6383@item MIN(@var{t})
6384Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6385
6386@item ODD(@var{i})
6387Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6388
6389@item ORD(@var{x})
6390Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6391value of a character is its ASCII value (on machines supporting the
6392ASCII character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6393integral, character and enumerated types.
6394
6395@item SIZE(@var{x})
6396Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6397
6398@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6399Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6400
6401@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6402Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6403@end table
6404
6405@quotation
6406@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6407@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6408an error.
6409@end quotation
6410
6411@cindex Modula-2 constants
53a5351d 6412@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6413@subsubsection Constants
6414
6415@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6416ways:
6417
6418@itemize @bullet
6419
6420@item
6421Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6422expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6423rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6424trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6425
6426@item
6427Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6428decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6429then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6430@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6431digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6432digits.
6433
6434@item
6435Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6436like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6437also be expressed by their ordinal value (their ASCII value, usually)
6438followed by a @samp{C}.
6439
6440@item
6441String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6442pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6443Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6444Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6445sequences.
6446
6447@item
6448Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6449
6450@item
6451Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6452@code{FALSE}.
6453
6454@item
6455Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6456
6457@item
6458Set constants are not yet supported.
6459@end itemize
6460
53a5351d 6461@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6462@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6463@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6464
6465If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6466both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6467Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6468selected the working language.
6469
6470If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6471code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6472working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6473the language automatically}, for further details.
6474
53a5351d 6475@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6476@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6477@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6478
6479A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6480This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6481
6482@itemize @bullet
6483@item
6484Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6485integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6486debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6487pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6488through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6489returned a pointer.)
6490
6491@item
6492C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6493non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6494escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6495printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6496
6497@item
6498The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6499argument.
6500
6501@item
6502All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6503@end itemize
6504
53a5351d 6505@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6506@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6507@cindex Modula-2 checks
6508
6509@quotation
6510@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6511range checking.
6512@end quotation
6513@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6514
6515@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6516
6517@itemize @bullet
6518@item
6519They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6520@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6521
6522@item
6523They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6524@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6525@end itemize
6526
6527As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6528whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6529
6530Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6531index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6532
53a5351d 6533@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6534@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6535@cindex scope
6536@kindex .
6537@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6538@ifinfo
d4f3574e 6539@kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6540@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6541@end ifinfo
6542@iftex
6543@kindex ::
6544@end iftex
6545
6546There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6547(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6548similar syntax:
6549
6550@example
6551
6552@var{module} . @var{id}
6553@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6554@end example
6555
6556@noindent
6557where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6558@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6559identifier within your program, except another module.
6560
6561Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6562specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6563found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6564enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6565
6566Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6567the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6568definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6569an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6570module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6571@var{module}.
6572
53a5351d 6573@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6574@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6575
6576Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6577Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6578specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6579@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6580apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6581analogue in Modula-2.
6582
6583The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6584with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6585intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6586created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6587address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6588@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6589
6590@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6591In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6592interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6593
53a5351d 6594@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6595@subsection Chill
6596
6597The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6598from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6599supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6600likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6601table.
6602
d4f3574e
SS
6603@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6604@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6605This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6606of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6607
6608@menu
104c1213
JM
6609* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6610* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6611* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
53a5351d
JM
6612* Chill type and range checks::
6613* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6614@end menu
6615
6616@node How modes are displayed
6617@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6618
6619The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6620with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6621slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6622provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6623
6624@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6625@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6626@table @code
6627@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6628@itemize @bullet
6629@item
6630@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6631UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6632@item
6633@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6634@item
6635@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6636@item
6637@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6638@smallexample
6639(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6640type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6641@end smallexample
6642If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6643@item
6644@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6645(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6646bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6647names).
6648@end itemize
6649
6650@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6651A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6652the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6653@smallexample
6654(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6655type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6656@end smallexample
6657
6658@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6659@itemize @bullet
6660@item
d4f3574e 6661@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6662followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6663@item
6664@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6665@end itemize
6666
6667@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6668The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6669<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6670list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6671the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6672all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6673
6674@ignore
6675@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6676The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6677type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6678@end ignore
6679
6680@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6681@itemize @bullet
6682@item
6683@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6684where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6685@item
6686@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6687<buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6688@end itemize
6689
6690@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6691@itemize @bullet
6692@item
6693@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6694@item
6695@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6696@end itemize
6697
6698@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6699Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6700
6701@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6702@itemize @bullet
6703@item
6704@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6705length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6706a varying mode
6707@item
6708@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6709length>)}.
6710@end itemize
6711
6712@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6713The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6714followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6715@smallexample
6716(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6717type = ARRAY (1:42)
6718 ARRAY (1:20)
6719 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6720@end smallexample
6721
6722@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6723The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6724list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6725of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6726OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6727of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6728checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6729always displays all variant fields.
6730@smallexample
6731(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6732type = STRUCT (
6733 as x,
6734 bs x,
6735 CASE bs OF
6736 (karli):
6737 cs a
6738 (ott):
6739 ds x
6740 ESAC
6741)
6742@end smallexample
6743@end table
6744
6745@node Locations
6746@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6747
6748A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6749
6750A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
6751the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6752Chill programs. How values are specified
6753is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6754
6755The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6756display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 6757
cce74817
JM
6758@smallexample
6759set result := EXPR
6760@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
6761
6762@noindent
6763This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
cce74817
JM
6764is not available in gdb).
6765
6766Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6767value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 6768mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
6769represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6770value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 6771operator @samp{->}.
cce74817
JM
6772
6773Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6774(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
d4f3574e 6775location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
cce74817
JM
6776parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6777address of the entry point.
6778
6779@ignore
6780Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6781fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6782the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
6783implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6784na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6785<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
6786@code{__proc_copy}.
6787
6788Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6789the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6790like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6791mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6792
6793Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 6794...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 6795definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
6796of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6797structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6798braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 6799on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 6800memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 6801all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 6802@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
6803stuff ???)
6804@smallexample
6805(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6806[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6807@end smallexample
6808@end ignore
6809
6810Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6811(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
6812certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6813and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6814
6815A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
6816location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6817name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6818have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6819checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 6820therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 6821
cce74817
JM
6822@smallexample
6823(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6824@end smallexample
6825
6826@node Values and their Operations
6827@subsubsection Values and their Operations
6828
6829Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6830more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
6831data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6832such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 6833constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 6834when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
6835(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6836the values behind these locations.
6837
d4f3574e 6838This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
6839operations are legal to be used with such values.
6840
6841@table @code
6842@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
6843Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
6844For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 6845chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
6846@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
6847@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817
JM
6848
6849@ignore
6850@itemize @bullet
6851@item
6852@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 6853programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
6854@item
6855@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
6856@item
6857@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
6858@code{'M'})
6859@item
6860@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
6861mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
6862comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 6863@item
d4f3574e 6864@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817
JM
6865emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
6866procedure value or the empty instance value.
6867
6868@item
6869@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 6870enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
6871to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
6872@item
6873@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6874programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
6875@item
6876@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 6877(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
6878@end itemize
6879@end ignore
6880
6881@item Tuple Values
6882A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 6883name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
6884unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
6885@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 6886
cce74817
JM
6887@itemize @bullet
6888@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
6889@item @emph{Array Tuple}
6890@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
6891Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 6892same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
6893@end itemize
6894
6895@item String Element Value
6896A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
d4f3574e 6897where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
6898value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
6899the string.
6900
6901@item String Slice Value
6902A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
6903spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
6904expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
6905@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
6906The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
6907string.
6908
6909@item Array Element Values
6910An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
6911delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
6912
6913@item Array Slice Values
6914An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
6915@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
6916@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
6917arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
6918which is part of the specified array.
6919
6920@item Structure Field Values
6921A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
6922name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
6923in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
6924corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
6925
6926@item Procedure Call Value
6927The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
6928procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
6929expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 6930effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 6931
d4f3574e 6932Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 6933
d4f3574e 6934Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
cce74817
JM
6935
6936@ignore
6937This is not implemented yet:
6938@item Built-in Value
6939@noindent
6940The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 6941
cce74817
JM
6942@table @code
6943@item @code{ADDR()}
6944@item @code{NUM()}
6945@item @code{PRED()}
6946@item @code{SUCC()}
6947@item @code{ABS()}
6948@item @code{CARD()}
6949@item @code{MAX()}
6950@item @code{MIN()}
6951@item @code{SIZE()}
6952@item @code{UPPER()}
6953@item @code{LOWER()}
6954@item @code{LENGTH()}
6955@item @code{SIN()}
6956@item @code{COS()}
6957@item @code{TAN()}
6958@item @code{ARCSIN()}
6959@item @code{ARCCOS()}
6960@item @code{ARCTAN()}
6961@item @code{EXP()}
6962@item @code{LN()}
6963@item @code{LOG()}
6964@item @code{SQRT()}
6965@end table
6966
6967For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
6968chapter 1.6.
6969@end ignore
6970
6971@item Zero-adic Operator Value
6972The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
6973current active process.
6974
6975@item Expression Values
6976The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 6977the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 6978incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 6979corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 6980causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 6981which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 6982operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 6983
cce74817
JM
6984@table @code
6985@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
6986@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
6987@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 6988Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 6989
cce74817
JM
6990@item @code{=, /=}
6991Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 6992
cce74817 6993@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 6994@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 6995Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 6996
cce74817 6997@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 6998@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 6999Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7000
cce74817
JM
7001@item @code{-}
7002Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7003
cce74817
JM
7004@item @code{//}
7005String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7006
cce74817
JM
7007@item @code{()}
7008String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7009
cce74817
JM
7010@item @code{->}
7011Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7012address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7013location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7014
cce74817 7015@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7016@itemx @code{AND}
7017@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7018Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7019
cce74817 7020@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7021@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7022Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7023
cce74817
JM
7024@item @code{IN}
7025Membership operator.
7026@end table
7027@end table
7028
53a5351d 7029@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7030@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7031
7032@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7033of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7034complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7035equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7036structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7037
7038Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7039index bounds and all built in procedures.
7040
7041Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7042check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7043operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7044functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7045language specification.
7046
cce74817
JM
7047All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7048off}.
7049
7050@ignore
53a5351d 7051@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7052see last paragraph ?
7053@end ignore
7054
53a5351d 7055@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7056@subsubsection Chill defaults
7057
7058If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7059both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7060Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7061selected the working language.
7062
7063If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7064code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7065working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7066the language automatically}, for further details.
7067
53a5351d 7068@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7069@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7070
d4f3574e 7071The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7072symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7073program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7074does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7075program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7076(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7077file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7078
7079@cindex symbol names
7080@cindex names of symbols
7081@cindex quoting names
7082Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7083characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7084most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7085source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7086are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7087ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7088@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7089@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7090
7091@example
7092p 'foo.c'::x
7093@end example
7094
7095@noindent
7096looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7097
7098@table @code
7099@kindex info address
7100@item info address @var{symbol}
7101Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7102variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7103local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7104is always stored.
7105
7106Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7107at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7108the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7109
7110@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7111@item whatis @var{expr}
7112Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7113actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7114assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7115@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7116
7117@item whatis
7118Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7119
7120@kindex ptype
7121@item ptype @var{typename}
7122Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7123the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7124@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7125@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7126
d4f3574e 7127@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7128@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7129Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7130differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7131of just the name of the type.
7132
7133For example, for this variable declaration:
7134
7135@example
7136struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7137@end example
7138
7139@noindent
7140the two commands give this output:
7141
7142@example
7143@group
7144(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7145type = struct complex
7146(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7147type = struct complex @{
7148 double real;
7149 double imag;
7150@}
7151@end group
7152@end example
7153
7154@noindent
7155As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7156the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7157
7158@kindex info types
7159@item info types @var{regexp}
7160@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7161Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7162(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7163complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7164@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7165names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7166information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7167
7168This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7169@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7170lists all source files where a type is defined.
7171
7172@kindex info source
7173@item info source
7174Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7175the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7176it was written in.
7177
7178@kindex info sources
7179@item info sources
7180Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7181debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7182have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7183
7184@kindex info functions
7185@item info functions
7186Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7187
7188@item info functions @var{regexp}
7189Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7190whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7191Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7192include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7193start with @code{step}.
7194
7195@kindex info variables
7196@item info variables
7197Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7198outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7199
7200@item info variables @var{regexp}
7201Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7202variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7203@var{regexp}.
7204
7205@ignore
7206This was never implemented.
7207@kindex info methods
7208@item info methods
7209@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7210The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7211methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7212specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7213C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7214from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7215@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7216which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7217@end ignore
7218
c906108c
SS
7219@cindex reloading symbols
7220Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7221be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7222in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7223running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7224@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7225
7226@table @code
7227@kindex set symbol-reloading
7228@item set symbol-reloading on
7229Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7230object file with a particular name is seen again.
7231
7232@item set symbol-reloading off
7233Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7234the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7235system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7236@code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7237when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7238different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7239
7240@kindex show symbol-reloading
7241@item show symbol-reloading
7242Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7243@end table
c906108c 7244
c906108c
SS
7245@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7246@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7247Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7248declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7249@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7250source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7251another source file. The default is on.
7252
7253A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7254the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7255
7256@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7257Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7258is printed as follows:
7259@smallexample
7260@{<no data fields>@}
7261@end smallexample
7262
7263@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7264@item show opaque-type-resolution
7265Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7266
7267@kindex maint print symbols
7268@cindex symbol dump
7269@kindex maint print psymbols
7270@cindex partial symbol dump
7271@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7272@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7273@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7274Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7275These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7276symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7277symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7278collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7279only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7280command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7281use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7282symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7283files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7284@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7285required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7286@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7287@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7288@end table
7289
53a5351d 7290@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7291@chapter Altering Execution
7292
7293Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7294find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7295correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7296experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7297program.
7298
7299For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7300locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7301address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7302
7303@menu
7304* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7305* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7306* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7307* Returning:: Returning from a function
7308* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7309* Patching:: Patching your program
7310@end menu
7311
53a5351d 7312@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7313@section Assignment to variables
7314
7315@cindex assignment
7316@cindex setting variables
7317To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7318@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7319
7320@example
7321print x=4
7322@end example
7323
7324@noindent
7325stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7326value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7327@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7328information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7329
7330@kindex set variable
7331@cindex variables, setting
7332If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7333@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7334really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7335not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7336,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7337
c906108c
SS
7338If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7339appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7340variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7341to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7342program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7343a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7344command @code{set width}:
7345
7346@example
7347(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7348type = double
7349(@value{GDBP}) p width
7350$4 = 13
7351(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7352Invalid syntax in expression.
7353@end example
7354
7355@noindent
7356The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7357order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7358
7359@example
7360(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7361@end example
53a5351d 7362
c906108c
SS
7363Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7364with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7365@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7366your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7367to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7368the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7369
7370@example
7371@group
7372(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7373type = double
7374(@value{GDBP}) p g
7375$1 = 1
7376(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7377(gdb) p g
7378$2 = 1
7379(@value{GDBP}) r
7380The program being debugged has been started already.
7381Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7382Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7383"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7384(@value{GDBP}) show g
7385The current BFD target is "=4".
7386@end group
7387@end example
7388
7389@noindent
7390The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7391@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7392@code{g}, use
7393
7394@example
7395(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7396@end example
c906108c
SS
7397
7398@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7399freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7400and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7401same length or shorter.
7402@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7403@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7404
7405To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7406construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7407(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7408to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7409and representation in memory), and
7410
7411@example
7412set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7413@end example
7414
7415@noindent
7416stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7417
53a5351d 7418@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7419@section Continuing at a different address
7420
7421Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7422it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7423an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7424
7425@table @code
7426@kindex jump
7427@item jump @var{linespec}
7428Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7429immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7430source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7431@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7432in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7433breakpoints}.
7434
7435The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7436the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7437register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7438a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7439be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7440of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7441confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7442executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7443well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7444
7445@item jump *@var{address}
7446Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7447@end table
7448
c906108c 7449@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7450On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7451command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7452difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7453changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7454example,
c906108c
SS
7455
7456@example
7457set $pc = 0x485
7458@end example
7459
7460@noindent
7461makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7462address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7463@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7464
7465The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7466up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7467that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7468detail.
7469
c906108c 7470@c @group
53a5351d 7471@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7472@section Giving your program a signal
7473
7474@table @code
7475@kindex signal
7476@item signal @var{signal}
7477Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7478signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7479signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7480SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7481
7482Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7483giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7484a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7485@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7486signal.
7487
7488@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7489after executing the command.
7490@end table
7491@c @end group
7492
7493Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7494@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7495causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7496the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7497passes the signal directly to your program.
7498
c906108c 7499
53a5351d 7500@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7501@section Returning from a function
7502
7503@table @code
7504@cindex returning from a function
7505@kindex return
7506@item return
7507@itemx return @var{expression}
7508You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7509command. If you give an
7510@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7511value.
7512@end table
7513
7514When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7515(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7516discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7517be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7518
7519This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7520frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7521innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7522specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7523of functions.
7524
7525The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7526program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7527returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7528and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7529selected stack frame returns naturally.
7530
53a5351d 7531@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7532@section Calling program functions
7533
7534@cindex calling functions
7535@kindex call
7536@table @code
7537@item call @var{expr}
7538Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7539returned values.
7540@end table
7541
7542You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7543execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7544with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7545is printed and saved in the value history.
7546
c906108c
SS
7547For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7548specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7549calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7550method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7551that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7552
53a5351d 7553@node Patching
c906108c 7554@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7555
c906108c
SS
7556@cindex patching binaries
7557@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7558@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7559
7a292a7a
SS
7560By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7561executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7562alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7563patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7564
7565If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7566explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7567want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7568repairs.
7569
7570@table @code
7571@kindex set write
7572@item set write on
7573@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7574If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7575core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7576off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7577
7578If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7579@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7580write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7581
7582@item show write
7583@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7584Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7585as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7586@end table
7587
53a5351d 7588@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7589@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7590
7a292a7a
SS
7591@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7592both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7593program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7594@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7595
7596@menu
7597* Files:: Commands to specify files
7598* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7599@end menu
7600
53a5351d 7601@node Files
c906108c 7602@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7603
7a292a7a 7604@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7605@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7606
7607You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7608way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7609@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7610Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7611
7612Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7613@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7614a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7615to specify new files are useful.
7616
7617@table @code
7618@cindex executable file
7619@kindex file
7620@item file @var{filename}
7621Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7622symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7623executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7624directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7625@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7626directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7627to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7628and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7629
c906108c
SS
7630On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7631@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7632@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7633@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7634descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7635(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7636@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7637for more information.
c906108c
SS
7638
7639@item file
7640@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7641has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7642
7643@kindex exec-file
7644@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7645Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7646in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7647if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7648discard information on the executable file.
7649
7650@kindex symbol-file
7651@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7652Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7653searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7654table and program to run from the same file.
7655
7656@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7657program's symbol table.
7658
7659The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7660of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7661auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7662the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7663the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7664
7665@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7666executing it once.
7667
7668When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7669understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7670generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7671other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7672Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7673using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7674optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7675
7676For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7677using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7678symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7679quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7680details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7681
7682The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7683start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7684occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7685file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7686pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7687warnings and messages}.)
7688
c906108c
SS
7689We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7690symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7691symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7692still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7693in stabs format.
7694
7695@kindex readnow
7696@cindex reading symbols immediately
7697@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7698@kindex mapped
7699@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7700@cindex saving symbol table
7701@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7702@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7703You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7704tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7705load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7706entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7707
c906108c
SS
7708If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7709@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7710cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7711file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7712from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7713than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7714program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7715starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7716
7717You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7718file has all the symbol information for your program.
7719
7720The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7721@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7722than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7723it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7724needed.
7725
7726The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7727@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7728symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7729
7730@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7731@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7732@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7733@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7734@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7735@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7736@c files.
7737
7738@kindex core
7739@kindex core-file
7740@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7741Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7742of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7743address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7744executable file itself for other parts.
7745
7746@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7747to be used.
7748
7749Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
7750under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7751wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7752the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 7753(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 7754
c906108c
SS
7755@kindex add-symbol-file
7756@cindex dynamic linking
7757@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7758@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7759The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7760from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7761has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7762is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7763file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
7764You can specify @var{address} as an expression.
7765
7766The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7767originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7768@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7769read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7770use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7771
7772@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7773
7774You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7775the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7776table information for @var{filename}.
7777
7778@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7779@item add-shared-symbol-file
7780The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7781operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7782shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7783@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 7784
c906108c
SS
7785@kindex section
7786@item section
7787The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7788the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7789section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7790specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
7791separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7792the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
7793
7794@kindex info files
7795@kindex info target
7796@item info files
7797@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
7798@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7799current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7800including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7801use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7802command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7803current ones.
7804
c906108c
SS
7805@end table
7806
7807All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7808as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7809name and remembers it that way.
7810
c906108c 7811@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
7812@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7813libraries.
53a5351d 7814
c906108c
SS
7815@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7816when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7817(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7818references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7819debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
7820
7821On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7822automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7823
c906108c
SS
7824@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7825@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7826@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7827
7828@table @code
7829@kindex info sharedlibrary
7830@kindex info share
7831@item info share
7832@itemx info sharedlibrary
7833Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7834
7835@kindex sharedlibrary
7836@kindex share
7837@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7838@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
7839Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7840Unix regular expression.
7841As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7842required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7843@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7844loaded.
7845@end table
7846
53a5351d
JM
7847On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
7848and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
7849a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
7850
7851Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
7852loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
7853@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
7854automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
7855
7856To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
7857
7858@table @code
7859@kindex set auto-solib-add
7860@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
7861Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
7862nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
7863automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
7864linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
7865the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
7866Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
7867@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
7868
7869@kindex show auto-solib-add
7870@item show auto-solib-add
7871Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
7872@end table
c906108c 7873
53a5351d 7874@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
7875@section Errors reading symbol files
7876
7877While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
7878such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
7879output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
7880they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
7881debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
7882about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
7883only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
7884times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
7885to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
7886complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7887messages}).
7888
7889The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
7890
7891@table @code
7892@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
7893
7894The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
7895(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
7896error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
7897in its outer scope blocks.
7898
7899@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
7900the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
7901may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
7902function.
7903
7904@item block at @var{address} out of order
7905
7906The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
7907order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
7908do so.
7909
7910@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
7911locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
7912can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
7913@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7914messages}.)
7915
7916@item bad block start address patched
7917
7918The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
7919smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
7920to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
7921
7922@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
7923starting on the previous source line.
7924
7925@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
7926
7927@cindex foo
7928Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
7929larger than the size of the string table.
7930
7931@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
7932name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
7933with this name.
7934
7935@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
7936
7a292a7a
SS
7937The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
7938not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 7939uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 7940
7a292a7a
SS
7941@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
7942This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 7943are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
7944debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
7945on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
7946and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
7947
7948@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 7949
7a292a7a 7950@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 7951
7a292a7a 7952@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 7953The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
7954information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
7955it.
c906108c
SS
7956
7957@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
7958
7959@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 7960
c906108c
SS
7961@end table
7962
53a5351d 7963@node Targets
c906108c 7964@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 7965
c906108c
SS
7966@cindex debugging target
7967@kindex target
7968
7969A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
7970
7971Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
7972in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
7973you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
7974flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
7975host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
7976realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
7977command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
7978(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
7979
7980@menu
7981* Active Targets:: Active targets
7982* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
7983* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
7984* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 7985* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
7986
7987@end menu
7988
53a5351d 7989@node Active Targets
c906108c 7990@section Active targets
7a292a7a 7991
c906108c
SS
7992@cindex stacking targets
7993@cindex active targets
7994@cindex multiple targets
7995
c906108c 7996There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
7997executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
7998active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
7999start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8000a core file.
c906108c
SS
8001
8002For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8003@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8004well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8005@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8006first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8007requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8008are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8009read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8010executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8011
8012When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8013target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8014commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8015an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8016process target is active.
c906108c 8017
7a292a7a
SS
8018Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8019core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8020files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8021the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8022process}).
c906108c 8023
53a5351d 8024@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8025@section Commands for managing targets
8026
8027@table @code
8028@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8029Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8030process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8031facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8032protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8033
8034Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8035typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8036with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8037
8038The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8039after executing the command.
8040
8041@kindex help target
8042@item help target
8043Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8044currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8045(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8046
8047@item help target @var{name}
8048Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8049select it.
8050
8051@kindex set gnutarget
8052@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8053@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8054knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8055a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8056with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8057with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8058
d4f3574e 8059@quotation
c906108c
SS
8060@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8061you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8062@end quotation
c906108c 8063
d4f3574e
SS
8064@noindent
8065@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c
SS
8066
8067@kindex show gnutarget
8068@item show gnutarget
8069Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8070@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8071@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8072and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8073@end table
8074
c906108c
SS
8075Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8076configuration):
c906108c
SS
8077
8078@table @code
8079@kindex target exec
8080@item target exec @var{program}
8081An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8082@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8083
c906108c
SS
8084@kindex target core
8085@item target core @var{filename}
8086A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8087@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8088
8089@kindex target remote
8090@item target remote @var{dev}
8091Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8092specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8093@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8094supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8095some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8096it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8097
c906108c
SS
8098@kindex target sim
8099@item target sim
104c1213
JM
8100Builtin CPU simulator. GDB includes simulators for most architectures.
8101In general,
8102@example
8103 target sim
8104 load
8105 run
8106@end example
d4f3574e 8107@noindent
104c1213 8108works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8109drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8110provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8111see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8112Processors}.
8113
c906108c
SS
8114@end table
8115
104c1213 8116Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8117
8118@table @code
8119
c906108c
SS
8120@kindex target nrom
8121@item target nrom @var{dev}
8122NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8123
c906108c
SS
8124@end table
8125
c906108c
SS
8126Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8127your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8128
8129Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8130once you've successfully established a connection.
8131
8132@table @code
8133
8134@kindex load @var{filename}
8135@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8136Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8137@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8138is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8139on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8140@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8141the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8142
8143If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8144execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8145target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8146
8147The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8148For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8149link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8150specifies a fixed address.
8151@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8152
c906108c
SS
8153@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8154@end table
8155
53a5351d 8156@node Byte Order
c906108c 8157@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8158
c906108c
SS
8159@cindex choosing target byte order
8160@cindex target byte order
8161@kindex set endian big
8162@kindex set endian little
8163@kindex set endian auto
8164@kindex show endian
8165
8166Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8167offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8168orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8169designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8170which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8171@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8172
8173@table @code
8174@kindex set endian big
8175@item set endian big
8176Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8177
8178@kindex set endian little
8179@item set endian little
8180Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8181
8182@kindex set endian auto
8183@item set endian auto
8184Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8185executable.
8186
8187@item show endian
8188Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8189
8190@end table
8191
8192Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8193data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8194target system.
8195
53a5351d 8196@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8197@section Remote debugging
8198@cindex remote debugging
8199
8200If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8201@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8202For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8203or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8204powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8205
8206Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8207to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8208@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8209but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8210write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8211communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8212
8213Other remote targets may be available in your
8214configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8215
c906108c 8216@menu
c906108c 8217* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8218@end menu
8219
104c1213
JM
8220@node Remote Serial
8221@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8222
104c1213
JM
8223@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8224To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8225@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8226prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8227program, you need:
c906108c 8228
104c1213
JM
8229@enumerate
8230@item
8231A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8232have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8233your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8234
104c1213 8235@item
d4f3574e 8236A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8237subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8238
104c1213
JM
8239@item
8240A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8241download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8242manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8243documentation.
8244@end enumerate
96baa820 8245
104c1213
JM
8246The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8247communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8248machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8249
104c1213
JM
8250@table @emph
8251@item On the host,
8252@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8253else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8254(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8255
8256@item On the target,
8257you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8258implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8259subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8260
8261On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8262@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8263@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8264@end table
96baa820 8265
104c1213
JM
8266The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8267machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8268@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8269
104c1213
JM
8270@cindex remote serial stub list
8271These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8272
104c1213
JM
8273@table @code
8274
8275@item i386-stub.c
8276@kindex i386-stub.c
8277@cindex Intel
8278@cindex i386
8279For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8280
8281@item m68k-stub.c
8282@kindex m68k-stub.c
8283@cindex Motorola 680x0
8284@cindex m680x0
8285For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8286
8287@item sh-stub.c
8288@kindex sh-stub.c
8289@cindex Hitachi
8290@cindex SH
8291For Hitachi SH architectures.
8292
8293@item sparc-stub.c
8294@kindex sparc-stub.c
8295@cindex Sparc
8296For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8297
8298@item sparcl-stub.c
8299@kindex sparcl-stub.c
8300@cindex Fujitsu
8301@cindex SparcLite
8302For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8303
8304@end table
8305
8306The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8307recently added stubs.
8308
8309@menu
8310* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8311* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8312* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8313* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8314* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8315* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8316@end menu
8317
8318@node Stub Contents
8319@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8320
8321@cindex remote serial stub
8322The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8323subroutines:
8324
8325@table @code
8326@item set_debug_traps
8327@kindex set_debug_traps
8328@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8329This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8330program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8331beginning of your program.
8332
8333@item handle_exception
8334@kindex handle_exception
8335@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8336This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8337explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8338run when a trap is triggered.
8339
8340@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8341execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8342with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8343protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8344representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8345information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8346retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8347execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8348@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8349machine.
8350
8351@item breakpoint
8352@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8353Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8354breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8355way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8356machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8357pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8358@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8359simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8360again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8361your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8362@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8363
8364Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8365to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8366start of your debugging session.
8367@end table
8368
8369@node Bootstrapping
8370@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8371
8372@cindex remote stub, support routines
8373The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8374chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8375debugging target machine.
8376
8377First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8378serial port.
8379
8380@table @code
8381@item int getDebugChar()
8382@kindex getDebugChar
8383Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8384It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8385different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8386
8387@item void putDebugChar(int)
8388@kindex putDebugChar
8389Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8390It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8391different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8392@end table
8393
8394@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8395@cindex interrupting remote targets
8396If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8397running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8398for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8399character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8400remote system to stop.
8401
8402Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8403probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8404is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8405@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8406
8407Other routines you need to supply are:
8408
8409@table @code
8410@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8411@kindex exceptionHandler
8412Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8413handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8414way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8415are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8416containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8417@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8418its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8419might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8420exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8421@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8422and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8423you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8424should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8425
8426For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8427gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8428should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8429@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8430help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8431
8432@item void flush_i_cache()
8433@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8434On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8435instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8436instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8437
8438On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8439function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8440@end table
8441
8442@noindent
8443You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8444
8445@table @code
8446@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8447@kindex memset
8448This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8449memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8450@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8451either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8452@end table
8453
8454If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8455library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8456but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8457subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8458
8459
8460@node Debug Session
8461@subsubsection Putting it all together
8462
8463@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8464In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8465steps.
8466
8467@enumerate
8468@item
8469Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8470(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8471@display
8472@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8473@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8474@end display
8475
8476@item
8477Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8478
8479@example
8480set_debug_traps();
8481breakpoint();
8482@end example
8483
8484@item
8485For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8486@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8487
8488@example
8489void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8490@end example
8491
d4f3574e 8492@noindent
104c1213 8493but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
d4f3574e 8494function in your program; that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8495@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8496error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8497one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8498
8499@item
8500Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8501your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8502
8503@item
8504Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8505the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8506
8507@item
8508@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8509@c document that. FIXME.
8510Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8511whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8512
8513@item
8514To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8515as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8516This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8517of its pure text.
8518
d4f3574e 8519@item
104c1213 8520@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8521Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8522Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8523machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8524TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8525to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8526device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8527
8528@example
8529target remote /dev/ttyb
8530@end example
8531
8532@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8533To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8534@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8535terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8536
8537@example
8538target remote manyfarms:2828
8539@end example
8540@end enumerate
8541
8542Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8543step and continue the remote program.
8544
8545To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8546command.
8547
8548@cindex interrupting remote programs
8549@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8550Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8551interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8552program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8553and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8554interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8555
8556@example
8557Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8558Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8559@end example
8560
8561If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8562(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8563remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8564goes back to waiting.
8565
8566@node Protocol
8567@subsubsection Communication protocol
8568
8569@cindex debugging stub, example
8570@cindex remote stub, example
8571@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8572The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8573communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8574@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8575these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8576implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8577with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8578organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8579
8580However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8581the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8582target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8583it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8584
8585In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8586transmitted and received data respectfully.
8587
8588@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8589@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8590@cindex remote serial protocol
8591All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8592are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8593character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8594@var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8595@var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8596two-digit @var{checksum}:
8597
8598@example
8599@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8600@end example
8601@noindent
8602or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8603@example
8604@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8605@end example
8606
8607@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8608@noindent
8609The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8610characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8611consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
d4f3574e 8612@var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
104c1213
JM
8613
8614@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8615@noindent
8616The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8617acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8618@value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8619
8620When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8621response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8622the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8623retransmission):
8624
8625@example
8626<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8627-> @code{+}
8628@end example
8629@noindent
8630If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8631appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8632
8633@example
8634<- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8635-> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8636@end example
8637
8638The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8639debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8640the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8641when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8642
8643@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8644exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8645exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8646Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8647(unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8648otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8649suppressed.
8650
8651Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
8652means that the next character is an ASCII encoding giving a repeat count
8653which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8654@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8655where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8656characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8657value greater than 126 should not be used.
8658
8659Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8660loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8661character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8662
8663So:
8664@example
8665"@code{0* }"
8666@end example
8667@noindent
8668means the same as "0000".
8669
8670The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8671error number. That number is not well defined.
8672
8673For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8674(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8675protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8676on that response.
104c1213
JM
8677
8678Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8679their corresponding response @var{data}:
8680
8681@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8682@item Packet
8683@tab Request
8684@tab Description
8685
8686@item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8687@tab @code{!}
8688@tab
d4f3574e 8689Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
104c1213
JM
8690The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8691@item
8692@tab reply @samp{}
8693@tab
8694Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8695unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8696support protocol extensions.
8697
8698@item last signal
8699@tab @code{?}
8700@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8701Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8702and continue.
8703@item
8704@tab reply
8705@tab see below
8706
104c1213
JM
8707
8708@item reserved
8709@tab @code{a}
8710@tab Reserved for future use
8711
8712@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8713@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8714@tab
8715Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8716specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8717See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8718@item
8719@tab reply @code{OK}
8720@item
8721@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8722
8723@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8724@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8725@tab
8726Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8727transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8728transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8729acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8730to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8731ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8732specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8733that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8734happened.}
8735
8736@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8737@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8738@tab
8739Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8740breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8741@samp{z} packets.}
8742
8743@item continue
8744@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8745@tab
8746@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8747current address.
8748@item
8749@tab reply
8750@tab see below
8751
8752@item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8753@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8754@tab
8755Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8756@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8757@item
8758@tab reply
8759@tab see below
8760
d4f3574e 8761@item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
8762@tab @code{d}
8763@tab
d4f3574e 8764toggle debug flag.
104c1213
JM
8765
8766@item detach @emph{(optional)}
8767@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e
SS
8768@tab
8769Detach GDB from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8770GDB disconnects.
8771@item
8772@tab reply @emph{no response}
8773@tab
8774GDB does not check for any response after sending this packet
104c1213
JM
8775
8776@item reserved
8777@tab @code{e}
8778@tab Reserved for future use
8779
8780@item reserved
8781@tab @code{E}
8782@tab Reserved for future use
8783
8784@item reserved
8785@tab @code{f}
8786@tab Reserved for future use
8787
8788@item reserved
8789@tab @code{F}
8790@tab Reserved for future use
8791
8792@item read registers
8793@tab @code{g}
8794@tab Read general registers.
8795@item
8796@tab reply @var{XX...}
8797@tab
8798Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8799with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e
SS
8800each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
8801determined by the GDB internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
8802@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8803@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
8804@item
8805@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8806@tab for an error.
8807
8808@item write regs
8809@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8810@tab
8811See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8812@item
8813@tab reply @code{OK}
8814@tab for success
8815@item
8816@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8817@tab for an error
8818
8819@item reserved
8820@tab @code{h}
8821@tab Reserved for future use
8822
8823@item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8824@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8825@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8826Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
8827@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
8828continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
8829thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
8830@item
8831@tab reply @code{OK}
8832@tab for success
8833@item
8834@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8835@tab for an error
8836
d4f3574e
SS
8837@c FIXME: JTC:
8838@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
8839@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
8840@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
8841@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
8842@c described. For example:
8843@c
8844@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8845@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
8846@c otherwise returns current registers.
8847@c
8848@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8849@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
8850@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
8851
104c1213
JM
8852@item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8853@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
8854@tab
8855Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
8856present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
8857step starting at that address.
8858
8859@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8860@tab @code{I}
8861@tab
8862See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
8863
8864@item reserved
8865@tab @code{j}
8866@tab Reserved for future use
8867
8868@item reserved
8869@tab @code{J}
8870@tab Reserved for future use
8871
8872@item kill request @emph{(optional)}
8873@tab @code{k}
8874@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8875FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
8876thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
8877
8878@item reserved
8879@tab @code{l}
8880@tab Reserved for future use
8881
8882@item reserved
8883@tab @code{L}
8884@tab Reserved for future use
8885
8886@item read memory
8887@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8888@tab
8889Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
d4f3574e
SS
8890Neither GDB nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
8891using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8892transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8893@item
8894@tab reply @var{XX...}
8895@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8896@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
8897to read only part of the data. Neither GDB nor the stub assume that
8898sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
8899@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8900@item
8901@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8902@tab @var{NN} is errno
8903
8904@item write mem
8905@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
8906@tab
8907Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8908@var{XX...} is the data.
8909@item
8910@tab reply @code{OK}
8911@tab for success
8912@item
8913@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8914@tab
8915for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
8916written).
8917
8918@item reserved
8919@tab @code{n}
8920@tab Reserved for future use
8921
8922@item reserved
8923@tab @code{N}
8924@tab Reserved for future use
8925
8926@item reserved
8927@tab @code{o}
8928@tab Reserved for future use
8929
8930@item reserved
8931@tab @code{O}
8932@tab Reserved for future use
8933
8934@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
8935@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
8936@tab
8937See write register.
8938@item
8939@tab return @var{r....}
8940@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
8941
8942@item write reg @emph{(optional)}
8943@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
8944@tab
8945Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
8946digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
8947@item
8948@tab reply @code{OK}
8949@tab for success
8950@item
8951@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8952@tab for an error
8953
8954@item general query @emph{(optional)}
8955@tab @code{q}@var{query}
8956@tab
d4f3574e 8957Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
104c1213 8958have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
8959company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
8960optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
8961must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
8962@item
8963@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 8964@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
8965@item
8966@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8967@tab error reply
8968@item
8969@tab reply @samp{}
8970@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
8971
104c1213
JM
8972@item general set @emph{(optional)}
8973@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
8974@tab
8975Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
8976naming conventions.
8977
d4f3574e
SS
8978@item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
8979@tab @code{r}
8980@tab
8981Reset the entire system.
104c1213
JM
8982
8983@item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
8984@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
8985@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8986Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
8987definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
8988packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213
JM
8989
8990@item step @emph{(optional)}
8991@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
8992@tab
8993@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8994same address.
8995@item
8996@tab reply
8997@tab see below
8998
8999@item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9000@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9001@tab
9002Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9003@item
9004@tab reply
9005@tab see below
9006
9007@item search @emph{(optional)}
9008@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9009@tab
9010Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9011@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9012bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213
JM
9013
9014@item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9015@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9016@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9017@item
9018@tab reply @code{OK}
9019@tab thread is still alive
9020@item
9021@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9022@tab thread is dead
9023
9024@item reserved
9025@tab @code{u}
9026@tab Reserved for future use
9027
9028@item reserved
9029@tab @code{U}
9030@tab Reserved for future use
9031
9032@item reserved
9033@tab @code{v}
9034@tab Reserved for future use
9035
9036@item reserved
9037@tab @code{V}
9038@tab Reserved for future use
9039
9040@item reserved
9041@tab @code{w}
9042@tab Reserved for future use
9043
9044@item reserved
9045@tab @code{W}
9046@tab Reserved for future use
9047
9048@item reserved
9049@tab @code{x}
9050@tab Reserved for future use
9051
9052@item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9053@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9054@tab
9055@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9056binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9057escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9058@item
9059@tab reply @code{OK}
9060@tab for success
9061@item
9062@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9063@tab for an error
9064
9065@item reserved
9066@tab @code{y}
9067@tab Reserved for future use
9068
9069@item reserved
9070@tab @code{Y}
9071@tab Reserved for future use
9072
9073@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9074@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9075@tab
9076See @samp{Z}.
9077
9078@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9079@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9080@tab
9081@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9082breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9083@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9084bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9085the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9086@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9087potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9088implemented in an ident-potentent way.
104c1213
JM
9089@item
9090@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9091@tab for an error
9092@item
9093@tab reply @code{OK}
9094@tab for success
9095@item
9096@tab @samp{}
9097@tab If not supported.
9098
9099@item reserved
9100@tab <other>
9101@tab Reserved for future use
9102
9103@end multitable
9104
d4f3574e
SS
9105The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9106receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9107@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9108when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9109number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9110conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9111
9112@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9113
9114@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9115@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9116
9117@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9118@tab
9119@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9120(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9121by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9122thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9123starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9124@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9125extend the protocol.
9126
9127@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9128@tab
9129The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9130applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9131
9132@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9133@tab
9134The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9135
9136@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9137@tab
9138@var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9139@var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
d4f3574e 9140section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
104c1213
JM
9141between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9142arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9143host debugger.}
9144
9145@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9146@tab
d4f3574e 9147@var{XX...} is hex encoding of ASCII data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9148while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9149for 'W', 'T', etc.
9150
9151@end multitable
9152
d4f3574e
SS
9153The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9154
9155@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9156
9157@item current thread
9158@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9159@tab Return the current thread id.
9160@item
9161@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9162@tab
9163Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9164@item
9165@tab reply *
9166@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9167
9168@item compute CRC of memory block
9169@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9170@tab
9171@item
9172@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9173@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9174@item
9175@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9176@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9177
9178@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9179@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9180@tab
9181Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9182digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9183subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9184number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9185(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9186returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9187@item
9188@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9189@tab
9190Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9191returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9192and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9193digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9194a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9195digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9196
9197@item query sect offs
9198@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
9199@tab Get section offsets.
9200@item
9201@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9202
9203@item thread info request
9204@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9205@tab
9206Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9207encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9208@item
9209@tab reply *
9210@tab
9211See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9212
9213@item remote command
9214@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9215@tab
9216@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9217execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9218Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9219number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9220packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9221stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9222@item
9223@tab reply @code{OK}
9224@tab
9225A command response with no output.
9226@item
9227@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9228@tab
9229A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9230@item
9231@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9232@tab
9233Indicate a badly formed request.
9234
9235@item
9236@tab reply @samp{}
9237@tab
9238When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9239
9240@end multitable
9241
9242The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9243In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9244bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9245space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9246The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9247least-significant.
9248
9249@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9250
9251@item MIPS32
9252@tab
9253All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
925432 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9255registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9256
9257@item MIPS64
9258@tab
9259All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9260thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9261as @code{MIPS32}.
9262
9263@end multitable
9264
104c1213
JM
9265Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9266does not get any direct output:
9267
9268@example
9269<- @code{R00}
9270-> @code{+}
9271@emph{target restarts}
9272<- @code{?}
9273-> @code{+}
9274-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9275<- @code{+}
9276@end example
9277
9278Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9279
9280@example
9281<- @code{G1445...}
9282-> @code{+}
9283<- @code{s}
9284-> @code{+}
9285@emph{time passes}
9286-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9287<- @code{+}
9288<- @code{g}
9289-> @code{+}
9290-> @code{1455...}
9291<- @code{+}
9292@end example
9293
d4f3574e
SS
9294@kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9295@kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
9296@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9297@cindex serial connections, debugging
9298If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9299@code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9300back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9301packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9302stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9303remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9304
9305@node Server
9306@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9307
9308@kindex gdbserver
9309@cindex remote connection without stubs
9310@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9311allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9312@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9313
9314@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9315because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9316that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9317@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9318@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9319because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9320also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9321started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9322Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9323the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9324do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9325by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9326choice for debugging.
9327
9328@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9329or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9330protocol.
9331
9332@table @emph
9333@item On the target machine,
9334you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9335@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9336strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9337system does all the symbol handling.
9338
9339To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9340the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9341syntax is:
9342
9343@smallexample
9344target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9345@end smallexample
9346
9347@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9348hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9349@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9350@file{/dev/com1}:
9351
9352@smallexample
9353target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9354@end smallexample
9355
9356@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9357with it.
9358
9359To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9360
9361@smallexample
9362target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9363@end smallexample
9364
9365The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9366specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9367TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9368expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9369(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9370you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9371TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9372reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9373conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9374and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9375@code{target remote} command.
9376
9377@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9378you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9379symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9380using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9381(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9382running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9383remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9384is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9385@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9386@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9387
9388@smallexample
9389(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9390@end smallexample
9391
9392@noindent
9393communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9394
9395@smallexample
9396(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9397@end smallexample
9398
9399@noindent
9400communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9401For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9402the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9403text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9404@samp{Connection refused}.
9405@end table
9406
9407@node NetWare
9408@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9409
9410@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9411@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9412allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9413@code{target remote}.
9414
9415@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9416using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9417
9418@table @emph
9419@item On the target machine,
9420you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9421@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9422can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9423host system does all the symbol handling.
9424
9425To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9426@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9427program. The syntax is:
9428
9429@smallexample
9430load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9431 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9432@end smallexample
9433
9434@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9435the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9436to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9437
9438For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9439communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9440using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9441
9442@smallexample
9443load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9444@end smallexample
9445
9446@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9447you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9448symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9449using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9450(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9451running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9452remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9453argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9454@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9455
9456@smallexample
9457(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9458@end smallexample
9459
9460@noindent
9461communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9462@end table
9463
9464@node KOD
9465@section Kernel Object Display
9466
9467@cindex kernel object display
9468@cindex kernel object
9469@cindex KOD
9470
9471Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9472@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9473and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9474mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9475displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9476
9477Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9478@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9479
9480@example
9481(gdb) set os cisco
9482@end example
9483
9484If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9485about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9486which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9487after the operating system:
9488
9489@example
9490(gdb) info cisco
9491List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9492Object Description
9493any Any and all objects
9494@end example
9495
9496Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9497by the kernel.
9498
9499There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9500is supported other than to try it.
9501
9502
104c1213
JM
9503@node Configurations
9504@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9505
9506While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9507cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9508describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9509
9510There are three major categories of configurations: native
9511configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9512operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9513different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9514are quite different from each other.
9515
9516@menu
9517* Native::
9518* Embedded OS::
9519* Embedded Processors::
9520* Architectures::
9521@end menu
9522
9523@node Native
9524@section Native
9525
9526This section describes details specific to particular native
9527configurations.
9528
9529@menu
9530* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9531* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9532@end menu
9533
9534@node HP-UX
9535@subsection HP-UX
9536
9537On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9538begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9539name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9540
9541@node SVR4 Process Information
9542@subsection SVR4 process information
9543
9544@kindex /proc
9545@cindex process image
9546
9547Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9548used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9549subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9550this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9551several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9552@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9553@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9554and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9555
9556@table @code
9557@kindex info proc
9558@item info proc
9559Summarize available information about the process.
9560
9561@kindex info proc mappings
9562@item info proc mappings
9563Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9564on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9565
9566@kindex info proc times
9567@item info proc times
9568Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9569its children.
9570
9571@kindex info proc id
9572@item info proc id
9573Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9574the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9575
9576@kindex info proc status
9577@item info proc status
9578General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9579stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9580received.
9581
9582@item info proc all
9583Show all the above information about the process.
9584@end table
9585
9586@node Embedded OS
9587@section Embedded Operating Systems
9588
9589This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9590embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9591architectures.
9592
9593@menu
9594* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9595@end menu
9596
9597@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9598various real-time operating systems.
9599
9600@node VxWorks
9601@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9602
9603@cindex VxWorks
9604
9605@table @code
9606
9607@kindex target vxworks
9608@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9609A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9610is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9611
9612@end table
9613
9614On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9615current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9616
9617@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9618VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9619the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9620both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9621@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9622installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
d4f3574e 9623@value{GDB} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9624
9625@table @code
9626@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9627@kindex vxworks-timeout
9628All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9629This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9630seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9631your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9632of a thin network line.
9633@end table
9634
9635The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9636this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9637procedures.
9638
9639@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9640To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9641to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9642library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9643VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9644kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9645source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9646information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9647manual.
9648@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9649
9650Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9651your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 9652run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or @code{vxgdb},
104c1213
JM
9653depending on your installation).
9654
9655@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9656
9657@example
9658(vxgdb)
9659@end example
9660
9661@menu
9662* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9663* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9664* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9665@end menu
9666
9667@node VxWorks Connection
9668@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9669
9670The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9671network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9672
9673@example
9674(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9675@end example
9676
9677@need 750
9678@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9679
9680@smallexample
9681Attaching remote machine across net...
9682Connected to tt.
9683@end smallexample
9684
9685@need 1000
9686@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9687loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9688these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9689path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9690to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9691
9692@example
9693prog.o: No such file or directory.
9694@end example
9695
9696When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9697the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9698command again.
9699
9700@node VxWorks Download
9701@subsubsection VxWorks download
9702
9703@cindex download to VxWorks
9704If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9705object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9706@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9707incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9708command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9709to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9710table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9711the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9712filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9713Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9714to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9715the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9716@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9717and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9718program, type this on VxWorks:
9719
9720@example
9721-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9722@end example
d4f3574e
SS
9723
9724@noindent
104c1213
JM
9725Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9726
9727@example
9728(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9729(vxgdb) load prog.o
9730@end example
9731
9732@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9733
9734@smallexample
9735Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9736@end smallexample
9737
9738You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9739after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9740this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9741auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9742history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 9743debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
9744table.)
9745
9746@node VxWorks Attach
9747@subsubsection Running tasks
9748
9749@cindex running VxWorks tasks
9750You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9751follows:
9752
9753@example
9754(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9755@end example
9756
9757@noindent
9758where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9759or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9760the time of attachment.
9761
9762@node Embedded Processors
9763@section Embedded Processors
9764
9765This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9766configurations.
9767
9768@menu
9769* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9770* ARM:: ARM
9771* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9772* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9773* i960:: Intel i960
9774* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9775* M68K:: Motorola M68K
9776* M88K:: Motorola M88K
9777* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9778* PA:: HP PA Embedded
9779* PowerPC: PowerPC
9780* SH:: Hitachi SH
9781* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9782* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9783* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9784* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9785@end menu
9786
9787@node A29K Embedded
9788@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9789
9790@menu
9791* A29K UDI::
9792* A29K EB29K::
9793* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9794* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9795* Remote Log:: Remote log
9796@end menu
9797
9798@table @code
9799
9800@kindex target adapt
9801@item target adapt @var{dev}
9802Adapt monitor for A29K.
9803
9804@kindex target amd-eb
9805@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9806@cindex AMD EB29K
9807Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9808@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9809@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9810name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9811@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9812
9813@end table
9814
9815@node A29K UDI
9816@subsubsection A29K UDI
9817
9818@cindex UDI
9819@cindex AMD29K via UDI
9820
9821@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9822protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9823configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9824program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9825use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9826@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9827
9828@table @code
9829@item target udi @var{keyword}
9830@kindex udi
9831Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9832@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9833This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9834connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9835working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9836to its pathname.
9837@end table
9838
9839@node A29K EB29K
9840@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9841
9842@cindex EB29K board
9843@cindex running 29K programs
9844
9845AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
9846with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
9847term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
9848@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
9849must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
9850board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
9851assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
9852@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
9853
9854@node Comms (EB29K)
9855@subsubsection Communications setup
9856
9857The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
9858in DOS on the PC:
9859
9860@example
9861C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
9862@end example
9863
9864@noindent
9865This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
9866bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
9867you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
9868end of the connection as well.
9869@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
9870@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9871@c
9872@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
9873@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
9874@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
9875@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
9876@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
9877
9878To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
9879the following at the DOS console:
9880
9881@example
9882C:\> CTTY com1
9883@end example
9884
9885@noindent
9886(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
9887the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
9888had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
9889
9890From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
9891@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
9892
9893@example
9894cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
9895@end example
9896
9897@noindent
9898The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
9899serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
9900may look something like the following:
9901
9902@example
9903tip -9600 /dev/ttya
9904@end example
9905
9906@noindent
9907Your system may require a different name where we show
9908@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
9909parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
9910@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
9911system table @file{/etc/remote}.
9912@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
9913@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
9914@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
9915@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
9916@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
9917@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
9918@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9919@c
9920@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
9921@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
9922@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
9923
9924@kindex EBMON
9925Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
9926directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
9927start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
9928with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
9929@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
9930@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
9931
9932@example
9933C:\> G:
9934
9935G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
9936
9937G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
9938Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
9939Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
9940Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
9941
9942Enter '?' or 'H' for help
9943
9944PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
9945I/O Base = 0x208
9946Memory Base = 0xd0000
9947
9948Data Memory Size = 2048KB
9949Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
9950Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
9951
9952PageSize = 0x400
9953Register Stack Size = 0x800
9954Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
9955
9956CPU PRL = 0x3
9957Am29027 Available = No
9958Byte Write Available = Yes
9959
9960# ~.
9961@end example
9962
9963Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
9964typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
9965running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
9966
9967For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
9968way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 9969system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
9970PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
9971something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
9972other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
9973from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
9974serial line.
9975
9976@node gdb-EB29K
9977@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
9978
9979Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
9980program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
9981name of your 29K program:
9982
9983@example
9984cd /usr/joe/work29k
9985@value{GDBP} myfoo
9986@end example
9987
9988@need 500
9989Now you can use the @code{target} command:
9990
9991@example
9992target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
9993@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
9994@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
9995@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9996@end example
9997
9998@noindent
9999In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10000@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10001@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10002In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10003a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10004the name on the Unix side.
10005
10006At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10007to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10008@code{run}.
10009
10010To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10011command.
10012
10013To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10014once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10015@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10016@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10017Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10018and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10019
10020@node Remote Log
10021@subsubsection Remote log
10022@kindex eb.log
10023@cindex log file for EB29K
10024
10025The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10026current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10027@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10028of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10029another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10030unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10031
10032@node ARM
10033@subsection ARM
10034
10035@table @code
10036
10037@kindex target rdi
10038@item target rdi @var{dev}
10039ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10040use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10041monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10042
10043@kindex target rdp
10044@item target rdp @var{dev}
10045ARM Demon monitor.
10046
10047@end table
10048
10049@node H8/300
10050@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10051
10052@table @code
10053
d4f3574e 10054@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10055@item target hms @var{dev}
10056A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10057Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10058line and the communications speed used.
10059
d4f3574e 10060@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10061@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10062E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10063
d4f3574e
SS
10064@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10065@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10066@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10067@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10068Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10069
10070@end table
10071
10072@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10073@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10074@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10075@cindex Hitachi SH download
10076When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10077board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10078board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10079@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10080
10081@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10082Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10083
10084@enumerate
10085@item
10086that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10087for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10088emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
10089the default when GDB is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
10090H8/300, or H8/500.)
10091
10092@item
10093what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10094serial device available on your host is the default).
10095
10096@item
10097what speed to use over the serial device.
10098@end enumerate
10099
10100@menu
10101* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10102* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10103* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10104@end menu
10105
10106@node Hitachi Boards
10107@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10108
10109@c only for Unix hosts
10110@kindex device
10111@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10112Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10113need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10114first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10115hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10116
10117@kindex speed
10118@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10119@code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
10120speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
10121hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside GDB with
d4f3574e
SS
10122the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10123@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10124
10125The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10126use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10127use a DOS host,
10128@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10129called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10130through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10131to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10132
10133The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10134program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10135sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10136the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10137
10138First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10139board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10140port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10141When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10142debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10143for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10144@code{COM2}.
10145
10146@example
10147C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10148C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10149
10150Resident portion of MODE loaded
10151
10152COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10153
10154@end example
10155
10156@quotation
10157@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10158@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10159disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10160your development board.
10161@end quotation
10162
d4f3574e 10163@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10164Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10165connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10166the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
10167you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10168commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10169cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10170download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10171the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10172(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10173executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10174@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10175itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10176
10177@smallexample
10178(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
10179GDB is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
10180 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10181 the conditions.
10182There is absolutely no warranty for GDB; type "show warranty"
10183for details.
10184GDB @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10185(gdb) target hms
10186Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
10187(gdb) load t.x
10188.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10189.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10190.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10191@end smallexample
10192
10193At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10194you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10195sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10196@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10197resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10198@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10199
10200Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10201available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10202you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10203
10204Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10205@itemize @bullet
10206@item
10207to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10208no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10209
10210@item
10211to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10212normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10213to detect program completion.
10214@end itemize
10215
10216In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10217development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10218
10219@node Hitachi ICE
10220@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10221
d4f3574e 10222@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10223You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10224Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10225e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10226
10227@table @code
10228@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10229Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10230@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10231@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10232(for example, @samp{9600}).
10233
10234@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10235If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10236specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10237@end table
10238
10239@node Hitachi Special
10240@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10241
10242Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10243
10244@table @code
10245
10246@kindex set machine
10247@kindex show machine
10248@item set machine h8300
10249@itemx set machine h8300h
10250Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10251architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10252to check which variant is currently in effect.
10253
10254@end table
10255
10256@node H8/500
10257@subsection H8/500
10258
10259@table @code
10260
10261@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10262@cindex memory models, H8/500
10263@item set memory @var{mod}
10264@itemx show memory
10265Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10266@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10267memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10268@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10269
10270@end table
10271
10272@node i960
10273@subsection Intel i960
10274
10275@table @code
10276
10277@kindex target mon960
10278@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10279MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10280
10281@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10282An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10283the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10284@file{/dev/ttya}.
10285
10286@end table
10287
10288@cindex Nindy
10289@cindex i960
10290@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10291@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10292tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10293
10294@itemize @bullet
10295@item
10296Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10297Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10298
10299@item
10300By responding to a prompt on startup;
10301
10302@item
10303By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10304session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10305
10306@kindex target nindy
10307@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10308An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10309the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10310@file{/dev/ttya}.
10311
10312@end itemize
10313
10314@cindex download to Nindy-960
10315With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10316downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10317@value{GDBN}.
10318
10319@menu
10320* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10321* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10322* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10323@end menu
10324
10325@node Nindy Startup
10326@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10327
10328If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10329options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10330reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10331
10332@example
10333Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10334@end example
10335
10336@noindent
10337Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10338identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10339simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10340with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10341use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10342
10343@node Nindy Options
10344@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10345
10346These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10347Nindy-960 board attached:
10348
10349@table @code
10350@item -r @var{port}
10351Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10352to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10353configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10354@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10355device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10356suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10357
10358@item -O
10359(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10360the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10361This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10362target architecture.
10363
10364@quotation
10365@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10366connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10367fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10368attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10369this process with an interrupt.
10370@end quotation
10371
10372@item -brk
10373Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10374system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10375
10376@quotation
10377@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10378requires; it only works with a few boards.
10379@end quotation
10380@end table
10381
10382The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10383port.
10384
10385@c @group
10386@node Nindy Reset
10387@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10388
10389@table @code
10390@item reset
10391@kindex reset
10392For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10393system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10394circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10395a break is detected.
10396@end table
10397@c @end group
10398
10399@node M32R/D
10400@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10401
10402@table @code
10403
10404@kindex target m32r
10405@item target m32r @var{dev}
10406Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10407
10408@end table
10409
10410@node M68K
10411@subsection M68k
10412
10413The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10414target command for the following ROM monitors.
10415
10416@table @code
10417
10418@kindex target abug
10419@item target abug @var{dev}
10420ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10421
10422@kindex target cpu32bug
10423@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10424CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10425
10426@kindex target dbug
10427@item target dbug @var{dev}
10428dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10429
10430@kindex target est
10431@item target est @var{dev}
10432EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10433
10434@kindex target rom68k
10435@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10436ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10437
10438@end table
10439
10440If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10441instead have only a single special target command:
10442
10443@table @code
10444
10445@kindex target es1800
10446@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10447ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10448
10449@end table
10450
10451[context?]
10452
10453@table @code
10454
10455@kindex target rombug
10456@item target rombug @var{dev}
10457ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10458
10459@end table
10460
10461@node M88K
10462@subsection M88K
10463
10464@table @code
10465
10466@kindex target bug
10467@item target bug @var{dev}
10468BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10469
10470@end table
10471
10472@node MIPS Embedded
10473@subsection MIPS Embedded
10474
10475@cindex MIPS boards
10476@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10477MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10478you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10479
10480@need 1000
10481Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10482
10483@table @code
10484@item target mips @var{port}
10485@kindex target mips @var{port}
10486To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10487name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10488command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10489the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10490been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10491download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10492
10493For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10494port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10495debugger:
10496
10497@example
10498host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10499GDB is free software and @dots{}
10500(gdb) target mips /dev/ttyb
10501(gdb) load @var{prog}
10502(gdb) run
10503@end example
10504
10505@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10506On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10507connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10508concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10509@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10510
10511@item target pmon @var{port}
10512@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10513PMON ROM monitor.
10514
10515@item target ddb @var{port}
10516@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10517NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10518
10519@item target lsi @var{port}
10520@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10521LSI variant of PMON.
10522
10523@kindex target r3900
10524@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10525Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10526
10527@kindex target array
10528@item target array @var{dev}
10529Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10530
10531@end table
10532
10533
10534@noindent
10535@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10536
10537@table @code
10538@item set processor @var{args}
10539@itemx show processor
10540@kindex set processor @var{args}
10541@kindex show processor
10542Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10543processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10544For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10545to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10546Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10547is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10548@value{GDBN} is using.
10549
10550@item set mipsfpu double
10551@itemx set mipsfpu single
10552@itemx set mipsfpu none
10553@itemx show mipsfpu
10554@kindex set mipsfpu
10555@kindex show mipsfpu
10556@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10557@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10558If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10559coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10560need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10561file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10562functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10563@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10564functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10565with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10566processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10567double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10568@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10569
10570In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10571floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10572and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10573
10574As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10575@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10576
10577@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10578@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10579@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10580@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10581@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10582@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10583@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10584@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10585You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10586by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10587@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10588to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10589at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10590
10591@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10592@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10593@itemx show timeout
10594@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10595@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10596@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10597@kindex set timeout
10598@kindex show timeout
10599@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10600@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10601You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10602remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10603default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10604waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10605retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10606You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10607retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10608@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10609
10610The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10611is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10612forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10613to run before stopping.
10614@end table
10615
10616@node PowerPC
10617@subsection PowerPC
10618
10619@table @code
10620
10621@kindex target dink32
10622@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10623DINK32 ROM monitor.
10624
10625@kindex target ppcbug
10626@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10627@kindex target ppcbug1
10628@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10629PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10630
10631@kindex target sds
10632@item target sds @var{dev}
10633SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10634
10635@end table
10636
10637@node PA
10638@subsection HP PA Embedded
10639
10640@table @code
10641
10642@kindex target op50n
10643@item target op50n @var{dev}
10644OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10645
10646@kindex target w89k
10647@item target w89k @var{dev}
10648W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10649
10650@end table
10651
10652@node SH
10653@subsection Hitachi SH
10654
10655@table @code
10656
d4f3574e 10657@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10658@item target hms @var{dev}
10659A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10660commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10661the communications speed used.
10662
d4f3574e 10663@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10664@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10665E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10666
d4f3574e
SS
10667@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10668@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10669@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10670@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10671Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10672
10673@end table
10674
10675@node Sparclet
10676@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10677
10678@cindex Sparclet
10679
10680@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10681Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10682@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10683both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
d4f3574e 10684@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
10685
10686@table @code
10687@item timeout @var{args}
10688@kindex remotetimeout
d4f3574e 10689@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
104c1213
JM
10690This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10691seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10692@end table
10693
10694@kindex Compiling
d4f3574e
SS
10695When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10696information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10697load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10698@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
10699
10700@example
10701sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10702@end example
10703
d4f3574e 10704You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
10705
10706@example
10707sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10708@end example
10709
10710@kindex Running
10711Once you have set
10712your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 10713run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
10714(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10715
10716@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10717
10718@example
10719(gdbslet)
10720@end example
10721
10722@menu
10723* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10724* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10725* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10726* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10727@end menu
10728
10729@node Sparclet File
10730@subsubsection Setting file to debug
10731
10732The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10733
10734@example
10735(gdbslet) file prog
10736@end example
10737
10738@need 1000
10739@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10740@value{GDBN} locates
10741the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10742path.
10743If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10744files will be searched as well.
10745@value{GDBN} locates
10746the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10747path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10748If it fails
10749to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10750
10751@example
10752prog: No such file or directory.
10753@end example
10754
10755When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10756the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10757@code{target} command again.
10758
10759@node Sparclet Connection
10760@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10761
10762The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10763To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10764
10765@example
10766(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10767Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10768main () at ../prog.c:3
10769@end example
10770
10771@need 750
10772@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10773
d4f3574e 10774@example
104c1213 10775Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 10776@end example
104c1213
JM
10777
10778@node Sparclet Download
10779@subsubsection Sparclet download
10780
10781@cindex download to Sparclet
10782Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10783you can use the @value{GDBN}
10784@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10785The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10786command.
10787Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 10788address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
10789offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10790of each of the file's sections.
10791For instance, if the program
10792@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10793and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10794
10795@example
10796(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10797Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10798@end example
10799
10800If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10801to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10802to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10803
10804@node Sparclet Execution
10805@subsubsection Running and debugging
10806
10807@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10808You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10809commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10810manual for the list of commands.
10811
10812@example
10813(gdbslet) b main
10814Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10815(gdbslet) run
10816Starting program: prog
10817Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
108183 char *symarg = 0;
10819(gdbslet) step
108204 char *execarg = "hello!";
10821(gdbslet)
10822@end example
10823
10824@node Sparclite
10825@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10826
10827@table @code
10828
10829@kindex target sparclite
10830@item target sparclite @var{dev}
10831Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10832You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10833For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10834remote protocol.
10835
10836@end table
10837
10838@node ST2000
10839@subsection Tandem ST2000
10840
10841GDB may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
10842STDBUG protocol.
10843
10844To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
10845manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
10846
10847@example
10848target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
10849@end example
10850
10851@noindent
10852to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
10853the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
10854ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
10855connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
10856concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10857
10858The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
10859this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
10860would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
10861(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
10862available on your host computer.
10863@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
10864@c basically hearsay.
10865
10866@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
10867These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
10868environment:
10869
10870@table @code
10871@item st2000 @var{command}
10872@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
10873@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
10874@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
10875Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
10876manual for available commands.
10877
10878@item connect
10879@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
10880Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
10881you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
10882sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
10883@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
10884@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
10885@end table
10886
10887@node Z8000
10888@subsection Zilog Z8000
10889
10890@cindex Z8000
10891@cindex simulator, Z8000
10892@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
10893
10894When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
10895a Z8000 simulator.
10896
10897For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
10898unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
10899segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
10900appropriate by inspecting the object code.
10901
10902@table @code
10903@item target sim @var{args}
10904@kindex sim
d4f3574e 10905@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
10906Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
10907options, specify them via @var{args}.
10908@end table
10909
10910@noindent
10911After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
10912CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
10913@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
10914to run your program, and so on.
10915
d4f3574e
SS
10916As well as making available all the usual machine registers
10917(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
10918additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
10919
10920@table @code
10921
10922@item cycles
10923Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
10924
10925@item insts
10926Counts instructions run in the simulator.
10927
10928@item time
10929Execution time in 60ths of a second.
10930
10931@end table
10932
10933You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
10934conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
10935conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
10936simulated clock ticks.
10937
10938@node Architectures
10939@section Architectures
10940
10941This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
10942all uses of GDB with this architecture, both native and cross.
10943
10944@menu
10945* A29K::
10946* Alpha::
10947* MIPS::
10948@end menu
10949
10950@node A29K
10951@subsection A29K
10952
10953@table @code
10954
10955@kindex set rstack_high_address
10956@cindex AMD 29K register stack
10957@cindex register stack, AMD29K
10958@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
10959On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 10960@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
10961extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
10962stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
10963memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
10964this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
10965the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
10966address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
10967hexadecimal.
10968
10969@kindex show rstack_high_address
10970@item show rstack_high_address
10971Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
10972processors.
10973
10974@end table
10975
10976@node Alpha
10977@subsection Alpha
10978
10979See the following section.
10980
10981@node MIPS
10982@subsection MIPS
10983
10984@cindex stack on Alpha
10985@cindex stack on MIPS
10986@cindex Alpha stack
10987@cindex MIPS stack
10988Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
10989sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
10990find the beginning of a function.
10991
10992@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
10993To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
10994@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
10995you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
10996commands:
10997
10998@table @code
10999@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11000@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11001Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11002search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11003default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11004larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11005and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11006
11007@item show heuristic-fence-post
11008Display the current limit.
11009@end table
11010
11011@noindent
11012These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11013for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11014
11015
c906108c
SS
11016@node Controlling GDB
11017@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11018
53a5351d
JM
11019You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11020@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11021data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11022described here.
c906108c
SS
11023
11024@menu
11025* Prompt:: Prompt
11026* Editing:: Command editing
11027* History:: Command history
11028* Screen Size:: Screen size
11029* Numbers:: Numbers
11030* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11031@end menu
11032
53a5351d 11033@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11034@section Prompt
11035
11036@cindex prompt
11037
11038@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11039called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11040can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11041instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11042the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11043which one you are talking to.
11044
d4f3574e 11045@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11046prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11047or a prompt that does not.
11048
11049@table @code
11050@kindex set prompt
11051@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11052Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11053
11054@kindex show prompt
11055@item show prompt
11056Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11057@end table
11058
53a5351d 11059@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11060@section Command editing
11061@cindex readline
11062@cindex command line editing
11063
11064@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11065@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11066command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11067or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11068substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11069debugging sessions.
11070
11071You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11072command @code{set}.
11073
11074@table @code
11075@kindex set editing
11076@cindex editing
11077@item set editing
11078@itemx set editing on
11079Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11080
11081@item set editing off
11082Disable command line editing.
11083
11084@kindex show editing
11085@item show editing
11086Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11087@end table
11088
53a5351d 11089@node History
c906108c
SS
11090@section Command history
11091
11092@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11093debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11094happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11095history facility.
11096
11097@table @code
11098@cindex history substitution
11099@cindex history file
11100@kindex set history filename
11101@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11102@item set history filename @var{fname}
11103Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11104This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11105list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11106exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11107the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11108to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11109@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11110is not set.
c906108c
SS
11111
11112@cindex history save
11113@kindex set history save
11114@item set history save
11115@itemx set history save on
11116Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11117@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11118
11119@item set history save off
11120Stop recording command history in a file.
11121
11122@cindex history size
11123@kindex set history size
11124@item set history size @var{size}
11125Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11126This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11127@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11128@end table
11129
11130@cindex history expansion
11131History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11132@ifset have-readline-appendices
11133@xref{Event Designators}.
11134@end ifset
11135
11136Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11137is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11138@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11139follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11140a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11141history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11142@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11143
11144The commands to control history expansion are:
11145
11146@table @code
11147@kindex set history expansion
11148@item set history expansion on
11149@itemx set history expansion
11150Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11151
11152@item set history expansion off
11153Disable history expansion.
11154
11155The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11156editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11157or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11158@ifset have-readline-appendices
11159@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11160@end ifset
11161
11162@c @group
11163@kindex show history
11164@item show history
11165@itemx show history filename
11166@itemx show history save
11167@itemx show history size
11168@itemx show history expansion
11169These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11170@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11171@c @end group
11172@end table
11173
11174@table @code
11175@kindex show commands
11176@item show commands
11177Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11178
11179@item show commands @var{n}
11180Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11181
11182@item show commands +
11183Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11184@end table
11185
53a5351d 11186@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11187@section Screen size
11188@cindex size of screen
11189@cindex pauses in output
11190
11191Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11192information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11193@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11194output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11195to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11196determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11197printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11198rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11199
d4f3574e
SS
11200Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11201driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11202together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11203@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11204you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11205width} commands:
11206
11207@table @code
11208@kindex set height
11209@kindex set width
11210@kindex show width
11211@kindex show height
11212@item set height @var{lpp}
11213@itemx show height
11214@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11215@itemx show width
11216These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11217a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11218commands display the current settings.
11219
11220If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11221output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11222file or to an editor buffer.
11223
11224Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11225from wrapping its output.
11226@end table
11227
53a5351d 11228@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11229@section Numbers
11230@cindex number representation
11231@cindex entering numbers
11232
11233You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in @value{GDBN} by
11234the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with @samp{0}, decimal
11235numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers begin with @samp{0x}.
11236Numbers that begin with none of these are, by default, entered in base
1123710; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
11238format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
11239both input and output with the @code{set radix} command.
11240
11241@table @code
11242@kindex set input-radix
11243@item set input-radix @var{base}
11244Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11245for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11246specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11247example, any of
11248
11249@smallexample
11250set radix 012
11251set radix 10.
11252set radix 0xa
11253@end smallexample
11254
11255@noindent
11256sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11257leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11258
11259@kindex set output-radix
11260@item set output-radix @var{base}
11261Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11262for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11263specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11264
11265@kindex show input-radix
11266@item show input-radix
11267Display the current default base for numeric input.
11268
11269@kindex show output-radix
11270@item show output-radix
11271Display the current default base for numeric display.
11272@end table
11273
53a5351d 11274@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11275@section Optional warnings and messages
11276
11277By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are running
11278on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} command.
11279This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy internal operation, so
11280you will not think it has crashed.
11281
11282Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11283which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11284see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11285
11286@table @code
11287@kindex set verbose
11288@item set verbose on
11289Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11290
11291@item set verbose off
11292Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11293
11294@kindex show verbose
11295@item show verbose
11296Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11297@end table
11298
11299By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an object
11300file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may find
11301this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading symbol files}).
11302
11303@table @code
11304@kindex set complaints
11305@item set complaints @var{limit}
11306Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of unusual
11307symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set @var{limit} to
11308zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number to prevent
11309complaints from being suppressed.
11310
11311@kindex show complaints
11312@item show complaints
11313Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11314@end table
11315
11316By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11317lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11318you try to run a program which is already running:
11319
11320@example
11321(@value{GDBP}) run
11322The program being debugged has been started already.
11323Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11324@end example
11325
11326If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11327commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11328
11329@table @code
11330@kindex set confirm
11331@cindex flinching
11332@cindex confirmation
11333@cindex stupid questions
11334@item set confirm off
11335Disables confirmation requests.
11336
11337@item set confirm on
11338Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11339
11340@kindex show confirm
11341@item show confirm
11342Displays state of confirmation requests.
11343@end table
11344
53a5351d 11345@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11346@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11347
11348Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11349command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of commands
11350for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command files.
11351
11352@menu
11353* Define:: User-defined commands
11354* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11355* Command Files:: Command files
11356* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11357@end menu
11358
53a5351d 11359@node Define
c906108c
SS
11360@section User-defined commands
11361
11362@cindex user-defined command
11363A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to which
11364you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the @code{define}
11365command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments separated by whitespace.
11366Arguments are accessed within the user command via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}.
11367A trivial example:
11368
11369@smallexample
11370define adder
11371 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11372@end smallexample
11373
d4f3574e
SS
11374@noindent
11375To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11376
11377@smallexample
11378adder 1 2 3
11379@end smallexample
11380
d4f3574e
SS
11381@noindent
11382This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
c906108c
SS
11383its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11384reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11385functions calls.
11386
11387@table @code
11388@kindex define
11389@item define @var{commandname}
11390Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11391by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11392
11393The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11394which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11395commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11396
11397@kindex if
11398@kindex else
11399@item if
11400Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11401It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11402only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11403There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11404by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11405was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11406
11407@kindex while
11408@item while
11409The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11410which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11411execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11412The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11413evaluates to true.
11414
11415@kindex document
11416@item document @var{commandname}
11417Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11418accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11419defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11420reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11421After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11422@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11423
11424You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11425documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11426does not change the documentation.
11427
11428@kindex help user-defined
11429@item help user-defined
11430List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11431(if any) for each.
11432
11433@kindex show user
11434@item show user
11435@itemx show user @var{commandname}
11436Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but not its
11437documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11438definitions for all user-defined commands.
11439@end table
11440
11441When user-defined commands are executed, the
11442commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11443stops execution of the user-defined command.
11444
11445If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11446without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11447commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11448messages when used in a user-defined command.
11449
53a5351d 11450@node Hooks
c906108c 11451@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11452@cindex command hooks
11453@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11454
11455You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11456command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11457command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11458before that command.
11459
d4f3574e 11460@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11461In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11462(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11463execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11464displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11465
c906108c
SS
11466For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11467single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11468you could define:
11469
11470@example
11471define hook-stop
11472handle SIGALRM nopass
11473end
11474
11475define hook-run
11476handle SIGALRM pass
11477end
11478
11479define hook-continue
11480handle SIGLARM pass
11481end
11482@end example
c906108c
SS
11483
11484You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11485not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11486name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11487@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11488@c or not?
11489If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11490@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11491(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11492
11493If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11494get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11495
53a5351d 11496@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11497@section Command files
11498
11499@cindex command files
11500A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11501commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11502An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11503the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11504
11505@cindex init file
11506@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11507@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c
SS
11508When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11509@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11510@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
d4f3574e
SS
11511any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
11512directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment variable.},
11513then processes command line options and
c906108c
SS
11514operands, and then reads the init file (if any) in the current working
11515directory. This is so the init file in your home directory can set
11516options (such as @code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of
11517the command line options and operands. The init files are not executed
11518if you use the @samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
11519
c906108c
SS
11520@cindex init file name
11521On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11522different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11523form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11524different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11525environments with special init file names:
11526
11527@kindex .vxgdbinit
11528@itemize @bullet
11529@item
11530VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11531
11532@kindex .os68gdbinit
11533@item
11534OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11535
11536@kindex .esgdbinit
11537@item
11538ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11539@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11540
11541You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11542@code{source} command:
11543
11544@table @code
11545@kindex source
11546@item source @var{filename}
11547Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11548@end table
11549
11550The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11551printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11552of the command file.
11553
11554Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11555without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11556normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11557when called from command files.
11558
53a5351d 11559@node Output
c906108c
SS
11560@section Commands for controlled output
11561
11562During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11563@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11564explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11565describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11566want.
11567
11568@table @code
11569@kindex echo
11570@item echo @var{text}
11571@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11572@c because it is not in ANSI.
11573Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11574@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11575newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11576In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11577by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11578string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11579trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11580To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11581@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11582
11583A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11584the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11585
11586@example
11587echo This is some text\n\
11588which is continued\n\
11589onto several lines.\n
11590@end example
11591
11592produces the same output as
11593
11594@example
11595echo This is some text\n
11596echo which is continued\n
11597echo onto several lines.\n
11598@end example
11599
11600@kindex output
11601@item output @var{expression}
11602Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11603newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11604value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11605on expressions.
11606
11607@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11608Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11609the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11610formats}, for more information.
11611
11612@kindex printf
11613@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11614Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11615@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11616either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11617@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11618subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
11619@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11620@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11621@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11622@c supported.
c906108c
SS
11623
11624@example
11625printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11626@end example
11627
11628For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11629
11630@smallexample
11631printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11632@end smallexample
11633
11634The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11635string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11636letter.
11637@end table
11638
53a5351d 11639@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
11640@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11641
11642@cindex Emacs
11643@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11644A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11645edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11646@value{GDBN}.
11647
11648To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11649executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11650@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11651created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 11652@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
11653
11654Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11655things:
11656
11657@itemize @bullet
11658@item
11659All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11660@end itemize
11661
11662This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11663and output done by the program you are debugging.
11664
11665This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11666commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11667in this way.
11668
11669All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11670with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11671way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11672stop.
11673
11674@itemize @bullet
11675@item
11676@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11677@end itemize
11678
11679Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11680source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11681left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11682source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11683and the source.
11684
11685Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11686usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11687
11688@quotation
11689@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11690current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11691the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11692appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11693environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11694session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11695back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11696avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11697your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11698@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11699
11700A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11701switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11702@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11703@end quotation
11704
11705By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11706you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11707several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11708Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11709
11710@example
11711(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11712@end example
11713
11714@noindent
d4f3574e 11715(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
11716in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11717``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11718
11719In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11720addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11721
11722@table @kbd
11723@item C-h m
11724Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11725
11726@item M-s
11727Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11728update the display window to show the current file and location.
11729
11730@item M-n
11731Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11732calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11733to show the current file and location.
11734
11735@item M-i
11736Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11737display window accordingly.
11738
11739@item M-x gdb-nexti
11740Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11741display window accordingly.
11742
11743@item C-c C-f
11744Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11745@code{finish} command.
11746
11747@item M-c
11748Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11749command.
11750
11751@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11752
11753@item M-u
11754Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11755(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11756like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11757
11758@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11759
11760@item M-d
11761Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11762@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11763
11764@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11765
11766@item C-x &
11767Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11768of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11769around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11770then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11771argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11772
11773You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11774@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11775otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11776inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11777wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11778list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11779formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11780is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11781@end table
11782
11783In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11784tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11785
11786If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11787it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11788request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11789the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11790frame.
11791
11792The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11793which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11794the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11795communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11796delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11797to correspond properly with the code.
11798
11799@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11800@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11801@ignore
11802@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11803@kindex Epoch
11804@kindex inspect
11805
11806Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11807called the @code{epoch}
11808environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11809@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11810each value is printed in its own window.
11811@end ignore
c906108c
SS
11812
11813@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
11814@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11815@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11816@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11817
11818Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11819
11820Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11821may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11822the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11823reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11824
11825In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11826information that enables us to fix the bug.
11827
11828@menu
11829* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11830* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11831@end menu
11832
53a5351d 11833@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
11834@section Have you found a bug?
11835@cindex bug criteria
11836
11837If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
11838
11839@itemize @bullet
11840@cindex fatal signal
11841@cindex debugger crash
11842@cindex crash of debugger
11843@item
11844If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
11845@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
11846
11847@cindex error on valid input
11848@item
11849If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
11850bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
11851somewhere in the connection to the target.)
11852
11853@cindex invalid input
11854@item
11855If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
11856that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
11857``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
11858for traditional practice''.
11859
11860@item
11861If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
11862for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
11863@end itemize
11864
53a5351d 11865@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
11866@section How to report bugs
11867@cindex bug reports
11868@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
11869
c906108c
SS
11870A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
11871If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
11872contact that organization first.
11873
11874You can find contact information for many support companies and
11875individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
11876distribution.
11877@c should add a web page ref...
11878
11879In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
11880@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
11881
11882@example
d4f3574e 11883bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
11884@end example
11885
11886@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 11887@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
11888not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
11889@samp{bug-gdb}.
11890
11891The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
11892serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
11893the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
11894newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
11895problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
11896path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
11897we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
11898bug reports to the mailing list.
11899
11900As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
11901
11902@example
11903@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
11904Free Software Foundation Inc.
1190559 Temple Place - Suite 330
11906Boston, MA 02111-1307
11907USA
11908@end example
c906108c
SS
11909
11910The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
11911@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
11912fact or leave it out, state it!
11913
11914Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
11915problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
11916assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
11917Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
11918stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
11919name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
11920of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
11921the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
11922easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
11923
11924Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
11925bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
11926you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
11927self-contained.
11928
11929Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
11930bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
11931@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
11932bugs properly.
11933
11934To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
11935
11936@itemize @bullet
11937@item
11938The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
11939with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
11940version}.
11941
11942Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
11943the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
11944
11945@item
11946The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
11947version number.
11948
c906108c
SS
11949@item
11950What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
11951``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
11952
11953@item
11954What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
11955debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
11956C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
11957information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
11958compilers.
11959
11960@item
11961The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
11962observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
11963you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
11964Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
11965
11966If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
11967and then we might not encounter the bug.
11968
11969@item
11970A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
11971reproduce the bug.
11972
11973@item
11974A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
11975incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
11976
11977Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
11978will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
11979not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
11980a chance to make a mistake.
11981
11982Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
11983say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
11984copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
11985the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
11986crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
11987ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
11988us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
11989to draw any conclusion from our observations.
11990
c906108c
SS
11991@item
11992If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
11993diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
11994it by context, not by line number.
11995
11996The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
11997sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 11998
c906108c
SS
11999@end itemize
12000
12001Here are some things that are not necessary:
12002
12003@itemize @bullet
12004@item
12005A description of the envelope of the bug.
12006
12007Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12008which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12009changes will not affect it.
12010
12011This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12012will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12013with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12014We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12015
12016Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12017of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12018output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12019less time, and so on.
12020
12021However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12022report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12023
12024@item
12025A patch for the bug.
12026
12027A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12028the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12029a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12030to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12031
12032Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12033construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12034through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12035to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12036
12037And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12038patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12039help us to understand.
12040
12041@item
12042A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12043
12044Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12045things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12046@end itemize
12047
12048@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12049@c and consists of the two following files:
12050@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12051@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12052@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12053@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12054@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12055@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12056
12057
c906108c 12058@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12059@appendix Formatting Documentation
12060
12061@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12062@cindex reference card
12063The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12064for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12065subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12066@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12067release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12068you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12069
12070The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12071can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12072
12073@example
12074make refcard.dvi
12075@end example
12076
12077The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12078mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12079that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12080high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12081your @sc{dvi} output program.
12082
12083@cindex documentation
12084
12085All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12086distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12087a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12088on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12089formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12090and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12091
12092@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12093version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12094file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12095subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12096necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12097but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12098Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12099@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12100
12101If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12102Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12103@code{makeinfo}.
12104
12105If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12106@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12107version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12108
12109@example
12110cd gdb
12111make gdb.info
12112@end example
12113
12114If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12115a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12116Texinfo definitions file.
12117
12118@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12119produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12120document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12121has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12122command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12123(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12124require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12125
12126@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12127@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12128written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12129typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12130and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12131directory.
12132
12133If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12134typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12135subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12136@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12137
12138@example
12139make gdb.dvi
12140@end example
12141
12142Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12143
53a5351d 12144@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12145@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12146@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12147@cindex installation
12148
c906108c
SS
12149@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12150of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12151build the @code{gdb} program.
12152@iftex
12153@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12154@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12155look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12156installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12157@end iftex
12158
12159The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12160@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12161appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12162
12163For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12164@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12165
12166@table @code
12167@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12168script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12169
12170@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12171the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12172
12173@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12174source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12175
12176@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12177@sc{gnu} include files
12178
12179@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12180source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12181
12182@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12183source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12184
12185@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12186source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12187
12188@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12189source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12190
12191@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12192source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12193@end table
12194
12195The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12196from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12197this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12198
12199First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12200if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12201identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12202argument.
12203
12204For example:
12205
12206@example
12207cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12208./configure @var{host}
12209make
12210@end example
12211
12212@noindent
12213where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12214@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12215(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12216correct value by examining your system.)
12217
12218Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12219@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12220libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12221binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12222
12223@need 750
12224@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12225system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12226shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12227
12228@example
12229sh configure @var{host}
12230@end example
12231
12232If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12233directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12234@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12235creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12236you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12237
12238You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12239subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12240configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12241
12242For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12243the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12244
12245@example
12246@group
12247cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12248../configure @var{host}
12249@end group
12250@end example
12251
12252You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12253However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12254the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12255that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12256let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12257
12258@menu
12259* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12260* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12261* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12262@end menu
12263
53a5351d 12264@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12265@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12266
12267If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12268you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12269host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12270allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12271rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12272handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12273@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12274program specified there.
12275
12276To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12277with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12278(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12279itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12280would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12281the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12282
12283For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12284separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12285
12286@example
12287@group
12288cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12289mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12290cd ../gdb-sun4
12291../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12292make
12293@end group
12294@end example
12295
12296When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12297directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12298(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12299the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12300directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12301@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12302
12303One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12304directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12305@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12306programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12307You specify a cross-debugging target by
12308giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12309
12310When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12311it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12312called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12313
12314The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12315directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12316directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12317directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12318will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12319
12320When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12321directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12322if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12323with each other.
12324
53a5351d 12325@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12326@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12327
12328The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12329script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12330aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12331of information in the following pattern:
12332
12333@example
12334@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12335@end example
12336
12337For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12338or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12339option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12340
12341The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12342any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12343aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12344@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12345script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12346abbreviations---for example:
12347
12348@smallexample
12349% sh config.sub i386-linux
12350i386-pc-linux-gnu
12351% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12352alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12353% sh config.sub hp9k700
12354hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12355% sh config.sub sun4
12356sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12357% sh config.sub sun3
12358m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12359% sh config.sub i986v
12360Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12361@end smallexample
12362
12363@noindent
12364@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12365directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12366
53a5351d 12367@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12368@section @code{configure} options
12369
12370Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12371are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12372several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12373Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12374
12375@example
12376configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12377 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12378 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12379 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12380 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12381 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12382 @var{host}
12383@end example
12384
12385@noindent
12386You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12387@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12388@samp{--}.
12389
12390@table @code
12391@item --help
12392Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12393
12394@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12395Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12396@file{@var{dir}}.
12397
12398@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12399Configure the source to install programs under directory
12400@file{@var{dir}}.
12401
12402@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12403@need 2000
12404@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12405@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12406@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12407Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12408@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12409build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12410directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12411the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12412directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12413the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12414@var{dirname}.
12415
12416@item --norecursion
12417Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12418propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12419
12420@item --target=@var{target}
12421Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12422@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12423programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12424
12425There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12426
12427@item @var{host} @dots{}
12428Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12429
12430There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12431@end table
12432
12433There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12434needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 12435
53a5351d 12436@node Index
c906108c
SS
12437@unnumbered Index
12438
12439@printindex cp
12440
12441@tex
12442% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12443% meantime:
12444\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12445\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12446\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12447\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12448\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12449\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12450\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12451\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12452\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12453\page\colophon
12454% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12455@end tex
12456
12457@contents
12458@bye
This page took 0.740651 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.